| 1 | % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
|
|---|
| 2 | %
|
|---|
| 3 | % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
|
|---|
| 4 | \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
|
|---|
| 5 | %
|
|---|
| 6 | \def\texinfoversion{2004-11-25.16}
|
|---|
| 7 | %
|
|---|
| 8 | % Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
|
|---|
| 9 | % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software
|
|---|
| 10 | % Foundation, Inc.
|
|---|
| 11 | %
|
|---|
| 12 | % This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
|---|
| 13 | % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
|
|---|
| 14 | % published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at
|
|---|
| 15 | % your option) any later version.
|
|---|
| 16 | %
|
|---|
| 17 | % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
|
|---|
| 18 | % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
|
|---|
| 19 | % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
|---|
| 20 | % General Public License for more details.
|
|---|
| 21 | %
|
|---|
| 22 | % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
|---|
| 23 | % along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write
|
|---|
| 24 | % to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
|
|---|
| 25 | % Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
|
|---|
| 26 | %
|
|---|
| 27 | % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
|
|---|
| 28 | % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
|
|---|
| 29 | % restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
|
|---|
| 30 | %
|
|---|
| 31 | % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
|
|---|
| 32 | % reports; you can get the latest version from:
|
|---|
| 33 | % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
|
|---|
| 34 | % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
|
|---|
| 35 | % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
|
|---|
| 36 | % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
|
|---|
| 37 | % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
|
|---|
| 38 | %
|
|---|
| 39 | % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
|
|---|
| 40 | % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
|
|---|
| 41 | % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
|
|---|
| 42 | %
|
|---|
| 43 | % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
|
|---|
| 44 | % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
|
|---|
| 45 | % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
|
|---|
| 46 | % tex foo.texi
|
|---|
| 47 | % texindex foo.??
|
|---|
| 48 | % tex foo.texi
|
|---|
| 49 | % tex foo.texi
|
|---|
| 50 | % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
|
|---|
| 51 | % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
|
|---|
| 52 | % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
|
|---|
| 53 | % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
|
|---|
| 54 | %
|
|---|
| 55 | % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
|
|---|
| 56 | % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
|
|---|
| 57 | % full Texinfo distribution.
|
|---|
| 58 | %
|
|---|
| 59 | % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
|
|---|
| 60 |
|
|---|
| 61 |
|
|---|
| 62 | \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
|
|---|
| 63 |
|
|---|
| 64 | % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
|
|---|
| 65 | % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
|
|---|
| 66 | % they might have appeared in the input file name.
|
|---|
| 67 | \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
|
|---|
| 68 | \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
|
|---|
| 69 |
|
|---|
| 70 | \message{Basics,}
|
|---|
| 71 | \chardef\other=12
|
|---|
| 72 |
|
|---|
| 73 | % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
|
|---|
| 74 | % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
|
|---|
| 75 | \let\+ = \relax
|
|---|
| 76 |
|
|---|
| 77 | % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
|
|---|
| 78 | \let\ptexb=\b
|
|---|
| 79 | \let\ptexbullet=\bullet
|
|---|
| 80 | \let\ptexc=\c
|
|---|
| 81 | \let\ptexcomma=\,
|
|---|
| 82 | \let\ptexdot=\.
|
|---|
| 83 | \let\ptexdots=\dots
|
|---|
| 84 | \let\ptexend=\end
|
|---|
| 85 | \let\ptexequiv=\equiv
|
|---|
| 86 | \let\ptexexclam=\!
|
|---|
| 87 | \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
|
|---|
| 88 | \let\ptexgtr=>
|
|---|
| 89 | \let\ptexhat=^
|
|---|
| 90 | \let\ptexi=\i
|
|---|
| 91 | \let\ptexindent=\indent
|
|---|
| 92 | \let\ptexinsert=\insert
|
|---|
| 93 | \let\ptexlbrace=\{
|
|---|
| 94 | \let\ptexless=<
|
|---|
| 95 | \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
|
|---|
| 96 | \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
|
|---|
| 97 | \let\ptexplus=+
|
|---|
| 98 | \let\ptexrbrace=\}
|
|---|
| 99 | \let\ptexslash=\/
|
|---|
| 100 | \let\ptexstar=\*
|
|---|
| 101 | \let\ptext=\t
|
|---|
| 102 |
|
|---|
| 103 | % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
|
|---|
| 104 | % starts a new line in the output.
|
|---|
| 105 | \newlinechar = `^^J
|
|---|
| 106 |
|
|---|
| 107 | % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
|
|---|
| 108 | % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
|
|---|
| 109 | %
|
|---|
| 110 | \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
|
|---|
| 111 | \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
|
|---|
| 112 | \else
|
|---|
| 113 | \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
|
|---|
| 114 | \fi
|
|---|
| 115 |
|
|---|
| 116 | % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
|
|---|
| 117 | \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
|
|---|
| 118 | \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
|
|---|
| 119 | \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
|
|---|
| 120 | \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
|
|---|
| 121 | \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
|
|---|
| 122 | \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
|
|---|
| 123 | \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
|
|---|
| 124 | \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
|
|---|
| 125 | \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
|
|---|
| 126 | \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
|
|---|
| 127 | \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
|
|---|
| 128 | \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
|
|---|
| 129 | \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
|
|---|
| 130 | \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
|
|---|
| 131 | \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
|
|---|
| 132 | \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
|
|---|
| 133 | \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
|
|---|
| 134 | \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
|
|---|
| 135 | \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
|
|---|
| 136 | %
|
|---|
| 137 | \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
|
|---|
| 138 | \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
|
|---|
| 139 | \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
|
|---|
| 140 | \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
|
|---|
| 141 | \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
|
|---|
| 142 | \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
|
|---|
| 143 | \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
|
|---|
| 144 | \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
|
|---|
| 145 | \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
|
|---|
| 146 | \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
|
|---|
| 147 | \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
|
|---|
| 148 | \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
|
|---|
| 149 | %
|
|---|
| 150 | \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
|
|---|
| 151 | \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
|
|---|
| 152 | \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
|
|---|
| 153 | \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
|
|---|
| 154 | \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
|
|---|
| 155 |
|
|---|
| 156 | % In some macros, we cannot use the `\? notation---the left quote is
|
|---|
| 157 | % in some cases the escape char.
|
|---|
| 158 | \chardef\colonChar = `\:
|
|---|
| 159 | \chardef\commaChar = `\,
|
|---|
| 160 | \chardef\dotChar = `\.
|
|---|
| 161 | \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
|
|---|
| 162 | \chardef\questChar = `\?
|
|---|
| 163 | \chardef\semiChar = `\;
|
|---|
| 164 | \chardef\underChar = `\_
|
|---|
| 165 |
|
|---|
| 166 | \chardef\spaceChar = `\ %
|
|---|
| 167 | \chardef\spacecat = 10
|
|---|
| 168 | \def\spaceisspace{\catcode\spaceChar=\spacecat}
|
|---|
| 169 |
|
|---|
| 170 | % Ignore a token.
|
|---|
| 171 | %
|
|---|
| 172 | \def\gobble#1{}
|
|---|
| 173 |
|
|---|
| 174 | % The following is used inside several \edef's.
|
|---|
| 175 | \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
|
|---|
| 176 |
|
|---|
| 177 | % Hyphenation fixes.
|
|---|
| 178 | \hyphenation{
|
|---|
| 179 | Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
|
|---|
| 180 | ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
|
|---|
| 181 | data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
|
|---|
| 182 | man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
|
|---|
| 183 | par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
|
|---|
| 184 | spell-ing spell-ings
|
|---|
| 185 | stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
|
|---|
| 186 | wide-spread wrap-around
|
|---|
| 187 | }
|
|---|
| 188 |
|
|---|
| 189 | % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
|
|---|
| 190 | \newdimen\bindingoffset
|
|---|
| 191 | \newdimen\normaloffset
|
|---|
| 192 | \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
|
|---|
| 193 |
|
|---|
| 194 | % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
|
|---|
| 195 | % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
|
|---|
| 196 | % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
|
|---|
| 197 | %
|
|---|
| 198 | \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
|
|---|
| 199 |
|
|---|
| 200 | % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
|
|---|
| 201 | % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
|
|---|
| 202 | % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
|
|---|
| 203 | % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
|
|---|
| 204 | % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
|
|---|
| 205 | %
|
|---|
| 206 | \def\|{%
|
|---|
| 207 | % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
|
|---|
| 208 | \leavevmode
|
|---|
| 209 | %
|
|---|
| 210 | % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
|
|---|
| 211 | \vadjust{%
|
|---|
| 212 | % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
|
|---|
| 213 | % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
|
|---|
| 214 | \vskip-\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 215 | %
|
|---|
| 216 | % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
|
|---|
| 217 | % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
|
|---|
| 218 | \llap{%
|
|---|
| 219 | %
|
|---|
| 220 | % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
|
|---|
| 221 | \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
|
|---|
| 222 | %
|
|---|
| 223 | % This is the space between the bar and the text.
|
|---|
| 224 | \hskip 12pt
|
|---|
| 225 | }%
|
|---|
| 226 | }%
|
|---|
| 227 | }
|
|---|
| 228 |
|
|---|
| 229 | % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
|
|---|
| 230 | % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
|
|---|
| 231 | % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
|
|---|
| 232 | % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
|
|---|
| 233 | % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
|
|---|
| 234 | %
|
|---|
| 235 | \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
|
|---|
| 236 | \def\loggingall{%
|
|---|
| 237 | \tracingstats2
|
|---|
| 238 | \tracingpages1
|
|---|
| 239 | \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
|
|---|
| 240 | \tracingparagraphs1
|
|---|
| 241 | \tracingoutput1
|
|---|
| 242 | \tracingmacros2
|
|---|
| 243 | \tracingrestores1
|
|---|
| 244 | \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
|
|---|
| 245 | \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging
|
|---|
| 246 | \tracingscantokens1
|
|---|
| 247 | \tracingifs1
|
|---|
| 248 | \tracinggroups1
|
|---|
| 249 | \tracingnesting2
|
|---|
| 250 | \tracingassigns1
|
|---|
| 251 | \fi
|
|---|
| 252 | \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
|
|---|
| 253 | \errorcontextlines16
|
|---|
| 254 | }%
|
|---|
| 255 |
|
|---|
| 256 | % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
|
|---|
| 257 | % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
|
|---|
| 258 | %
|
|---|
| 259 | \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
|
|---|
| 260 | \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
|
|---|
| 261 | \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
|
|---|
| 262 | \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
|
|---|
| 263 | \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
|
|---|
| 264 | \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
|
|---|
| 265 |
|
|---|
| 266 | % For @cropmarks command.
|
|---|
| 267 | % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
|
|---|
| 268 | %
|
|---|
| 269 | \newif\ifcropmarks
|
|---|
| 270 | \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue
|
|---|
| 271 | %
|
|---|
| 272 | % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
|
|---|
| 273 | % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
|
|---|
| 274 | %
|
|---|
| 275 | \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
|
|---|
| 276 | \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc
|
|---|
| 277 | \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
|
|---|
| 278 | \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
|
|---|
| 279 |
|
|---|
| 280 | % Main output routine.
|
|---|
| 281 | \chardef\PAGE = 255
|
|---|
| 282 | \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
|
|---|
| 283 |
|
|---|
| 284 | \newbox\headlinebox
|
|---|
| 285 | \newbox\footlinebox
|
|---|
| 286 |
|
|---|
| 287 | % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
|
|---|
| 288 | % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
|
|---|
| 289 | \def\onepageout#1{%
|
|---|
| 290 | \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
|
|---|
| 291 | %
|
|---|
| 292 | \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
|
|---|
| 293 | \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
|
|---|
| 294 | %
|
|---|
| 295 | % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
|
|---|
| 296 | % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
|
|---|
| 297 | \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
|
|---|
| 298 | \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}%
|
|---|
| 299 | %
|
|---|
| 300 | {%
|
|---|
| 301 | % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
|
|---|
| 302 | % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
|
|---|
| 303 | % before the \shipout runs.
|
|---|
| 304 | %
|
|---|
| 305 | \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
|
|---|
| 306 | \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
|
|---|
| 307 | \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
|
|---|
| 308 | % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
|
|---|
| 309 | \shipout\vbox{%
|
|---|
| 310 | % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
|
|---|
| 311 | \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
|
|---|
| 312 | %
|
|---|
| 313 | \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
|
|---|
| 314 | \hsize = \outerhsize
|
|---|
| 315 | \vskip-\topandbottommargin
|
|---|
| 316 | \vtop to0pt{%
|
|---|
| 317 | \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
|
|---|
| 318 | \nointerlineskip
|
|---|
| 319 | \line{%
|
|---|
| 320 | \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
|
|---|
| 321 | \hfill
|
|---|
| 322 | \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
|
|---|
| 323 | }%
|
|---|
| 324 | \vss}%
|
|---|
| 325 | \vskip\topandbottommargin
|
|---|
| 326 | \line\bgroup
|
|---|
| 327 | \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
|
|---|
| 328 | \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
|
|---|
| 329 | \vbox\bgroup
|
|---|
| 330 | \fi
|
|---|
| 331 | %
|
|---|
| 332 | \unvbox\headlinebox
|
|---|
| 333 | \pagebody{#1}%
|
|---|
| 334 | \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
|
|---|
| 335 | % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
|
|---|
| 336 | % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingxxx.)
|
|---|
| 337 | % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
|
|---|
| 338 | \vskip 2\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 339 | \unvbox\footlinebox
|
|---|
| 340 | \fi
|
|---|
| 341 | %
|
|---|
| 342 | \ifcropmarks
|
|---|
| 343 | \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
|
|---|
| 344 | \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
|
|---|
| 345 | \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
|
|---|
| 346 | \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick
|
|---|
| 347 | \vbox to0pt{\vss
|
|---|
| 348 | \line{%
|
|---|
| 349 | \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
|
|---|
| 350 | \hfill
|
|---|
| 351 | \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
|
|---|
| 352 | }%
|
|---|
| 353 | \nointerlineskip
|
|---|
| 354 | \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
|
|---|
| 355 | }%
|
|---|
| 356 | \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
|
|---|
| 357 | \fi
|
|---|
| 358 | }% end of \shipout\vbox
|
|---|
| 359 | }% end of group with \normalturnoffactive
|
|---|
| 360 | \advancepageno
|
|---|
| 361 | \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
|
|---|
| 362 | }
|
|---|
| 363 |
|
|---|
| 364 | \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
|
|---|
| 365 |
|
|---|
| 366 | \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
|
|---|
| 367 | {\catcode`\@ =11
|
|---|
| 368 | \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
|
|---|
| 369 | % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
|
|---|
| 370 | \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
|
|---|
| 371 | \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
|
|---|
| 372 | \dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1
|
|---|
| 373 | \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
|
|---|
| 374 | \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
|
|---|
| 375 | }
|
|---|
| 376 |
|
|---|
| 377 | % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
|
|---|
| 378 | % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
|
|---|
| 379 | % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
|
|---|
| 380 | %
|
|---|
| 381 | \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
|
|---|
| 382 | \def\nstop{\vbox
|
|---|
| 383 | {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
|
|---|
| 384 | \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
|
|---|
| 385 | \def\nsbot{\vbox
|
|---|
| 386 | {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
|
|---|
| 387 |
|
|---|
| 388 | % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
|
|---|
| 389 | % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
|
|---|
| 390 | % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
|
|---|
| 391 | %
|
|---|
| 392 | \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
|
|---|
| 393 | \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
|
|---|
| 394 | \def\next{#2}%
|
|---|
| 395 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 396 | \obeylines
|
|---|
| 397 | \spaceisspace
|
|---|
| 398 | #1%
|
|---|
| 399 | \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
|
|---|
| 400 | }
|
|---|
| 401 |
|
|---|
| 402 | {\obeylines %
|
|---|
| 403 | \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
|
|---|
| 404 | \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
|
|---|
| 405 | \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
|
|---|
| 406 | }%
|
|---|
| 407 | }
|
|---|
| 408 |
|
|---|
| 409 | % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
|
|---|
| 410 | \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
|
|---|
| 411 | \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
|
|---|
| 412 |
|
|---|
| 413 | % Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
|
|---|
| 414 | %
|
|---|
| 415 | % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
|
|---|
| 416 | % @end itemize @c foo
|
|---|
| 417 | % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
|
|---|
| 418 | % by \finishparsearg.
|
|---|
| 419 | %
|
|---|
| 420 | \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
|
|---|
| 421 | \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
|
|---|
| 422 | \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
|
|---|
| 423 | \def\temp{#3}%
|
|---|
| 424 | \ifx\temp\empty
|
|---|
| 425 | % We cannot use \next here, as it holds the macro to run;
|
|---|
| 426 | % thus we reuse \temp.
|
|---|
| 427 | \let\temp\finishparsearg
|
|---|
| 428 | \else
|
|---|
| 429 | \let\temp\argcheckspaces
|
|---|
| 430 | \fi
|
|---|
| 431 | % Put the space token in:
|
|---|
| 432 | \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
|
|---|
| 433 | }
|
|---|
| 434 |
|
|---|
| 435 | % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
|
|---|
| 436 | % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
|
|---|
| 437 | % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
|
|---|
| 438 | % just before passing the control to \next.
|
|---|
| 439 | % (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
|
|---|
| 440 | % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
|
|---|
| 441 | % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
|
|---|
| 442 | %
|
|---|
| 443 | % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
|
|---|
| 444 | %
|
|---|
| 445 | \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\next\expandafter{#1}}
|
|---|
| 446 |
|
|---|
| 447 | % \parseargdef\foo{...}
|
|---|
| 448 | % is roughly equivalent to
|
|---|
| 449 | % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
|
|---|
| 450 | % \def\Xfoo#1{...}
|
|---|
| 451 | %
|
|---|
| 452 | % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
|
|---|
| 453 | % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
|
|---|
| 454 |
|
|---|
| 455 | \def\parseargdef#1{%
|
|---|
| 456 | \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
|
|---|
| 457 | }
|
|---|
| 458 | \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
|
|---|
| 459 | \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
|
|---|
| 460 | \def#1##1%
|
|---|
| 461 | }
|
|---|
| 462 |
|
|---|
| 463 | % Several utility definitions with active space:
|
|---|
| 464 | {
|
|---|
| 465 | \obeyspaces
|
|---|
| 466 | \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
|
|---|
| 467 |
|
|---|
| 468 | % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
|
|---|
| 469 | % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
|
|---|
| 470 | % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
|
|---|
| 471 | % should produce a line of output anyway.
|
|---|
| 472 | %
|
|---|
| 473 | \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
|
|---|
| 474 |
|
|---|
| 475 | % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
|
|---|
| 476 | % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
|
|---|
| 477 | % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
|
|---|
| 478 | \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
|
|---|
| 479 | }
|
|---|
| 480 |
|
|---|
| 481 |
|
|---|
| 482 | \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
|
|---|
| 483 |
|
|---|
| 484 | % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
|
|---|
| 485 | %
|
|---|
| 486 | % \envdef\foo{...}
|
|---|
| 487 | % \def\Efoo{...}
|
|---|
| 488 | %
|
|---|
| 489 | % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
|
|---|
| 490 | % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
|
|---|
| 491 | % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
|
|---|
| 492 | % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
|
|---|
| 493 | % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
|
|---|
| 494 | %
|
|---|
| 495 | % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
|
|---|
| 496 | % are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group. (The
|
|---|
| 497 | % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
|
|---|
| 498 | % special case.)
|
|---|
| 499 |
|
|---|
| 500 |
|
|---|
| 501 | % At runtime, environments start with this:
|
|---|
| 502 | \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
|
|---|
| 503 | % initialize
|
|---|
| 504 | \let\thisenv\empty
|
|---|
| 505 |
|
|---|
| 506 | % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
|
|---|
| 507 | \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
|
|---|
| 508 | \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
|
|---|
| 509 |
|
|---|
| 510 | % Check whether we're in the right environment:
|
|---|
| 511 | \def\checkenv#1{%
|
|---|
| 512 | \def\temp{#1}%
|
|---|
| 513 | \ifx\thisenv\temp
|
|---|
| 514 | \else
|
|---|
| 515 | \badenverr
|
|---|
| 516 | \fi
|
|---|
| 517 | }
|
|---|
| 518 |
|
|---|
| 519 | % Evironment mismatch, #1 expected:
|
|---|
| 520 | \def\badenverr{%
|
|---|
| 521 | \errhelp = \EMsimple
|
|---|
| 522 | \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
|
|---|
| 523 | not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
|
|---|
| 524 | }
|
|---|
| 525 | \def\inenvironment#1{%
|
|---|
| 526 | \ifx#1\empty
|
|---|
| 527 | out of any environment%
|
|---|
| 528 | \else
|
|---|
| 529 | in environment \expandafter\string#1%
|
|---|
| 530 | \fi
|
|---|
| 531 | }
|
|---|
| 532 |
|
|---|
| 533 | % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
|
|---|
| 534 | % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
|
|---|
| 535 | %
|
|---|
| 536 | \parseargdef\end{%
|
|---|
| 537 | \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
|
|---|
| 538 | \else
|
|---|
| 539 | % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
|
|---|
| 540 | \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
|
|---|
| 541 | \csname E#1\endcsname
|
|---|
| 542 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 543 | \fi
|
|---|
| 544 | }
|
|---|
| 545 |
|
|---|
| 546 | \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
|
|---|
| 547 |
|
|---|
| 548 |
|
|---|
| 549 | %% Simple single-character @ commands
|
|---|
| 550 |
|
|---|
| 551 | % @@ prints an @
|
|---|
| 552 | % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr).
|
|---|
| 553 | \def\@{{\tt\char64}}
|
|---|
| 554 |
|
|---|
| 555 | % This is turned off because it was never documented
|
|---|
| 556 | % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures.
|
|---|
| 557 | %% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and '
|
|---|
| 558 | %% but suppressing ligatures.
|
|---|
| 559 | %\def\`{{`}}
|
|---|
| 560 | %\def\'{{'}}
|
|---|
| 561 |
|
|---|
| 562 | % Used to generate quoted braces.
|
|---|
| 563 | \def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}}
|
|---|
| 564 | \def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}}
|
|---|
| 565 | \let\{=\mylbrace
|
|---|
| 566 | \let\}=\myrbrace
|
|---|
| 567 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 568 | % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
|
|---|
| 569 | % and @{ and @} for the aux file.
|
|---|
| 570 | \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
|
|---|
| 571 | \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
|
|---|
| 572 | \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
|
|---|
| 573 | !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
|
|---|
| 574 | !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
|
|---|
| 575 | !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
|
|---|
| 576 | !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
|
|---|
| 577 | !endgroup
|
|---|
| 578 |
|
|---|
| 579 | % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
|
|---|
| 580 | \let\comma = ,
|
|---|
| 581 |
|
|---|
| 582 | % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
|
|---|
| 583 | % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
|
|---|
| 584 | \let\, = \c
|
|---|
| 585 | \let\dotaccent = \.
|
|---|
| 586 | \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
|
|---|
| 587 | \let\tieaccent = \t
|
|---|
| 588 | \let\ubaraccent = \b
|
|---|
| 589 | \let\udotaccent = \d
|
|---|
| 590 |
|
|---|
| 591 | % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
|
|---|
| 592 | % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
|
|---|
| 593 | \def\questiondown{?`}
|
|---|
| 594 | \def\exclamdown{!`}
|
|---|
| 595 | \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
|
|---|
| 596 | \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
|
|---|
| 597 |
|
|---|
| 598 | % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
|
|---|
| 599 | \def\imacro{i}
|
|---|
| 600 | \def\jmacro{j}
|
|---|
| 601 | \def\dotless#1{%
|
|---|
| 602 | \def\temp{#1}%
|
|---|
| 603 | \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi
|
|---|
| 604 | \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j
|
|---|
| 605 | \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
|
|---|
| 606 | \fi\fi
|
|---|
| 607 | }
|
|---|
| 608 |
|
|---|
| 609 | % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
|
|---|
| 610 | % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
|
|---|
| 611 | %
|
|---|
| 612 | \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
|
|---|
| 613 |
|
|---|
| 614 | % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
|
|---|
| 615 | % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
|
|---|
| 616 | % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
|
|---|
| 617 | % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
|
|---|
| 618 | % \scriptscriptstyle).
|
|---|
| 619 | %
|
|---|
| 620 | \def\LaTeX{%
|
|---|
| 621 | L\kern-.36em
|
|---|
| 622 | {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
|
|---|
| 623 | \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}%
|
|---|
| 624 | \kern-.15em
|
|---|
| 625 | \TeX
|
|---|
| 626 | }
|
|---|
| 627 |
|
|---|
| 628 | % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
|
|---|
| 629 | % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
|
|---|
| 630 | % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
|
|---|
| 631 | % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
|
|---|
| 632 | % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
|
|---|
| 633 | {\catcode`@ = 11
|
|---|
| 634 | % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
|
|---|
| 635 | % if the definition is written into an index file.
|
|---|
| 636 | \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
|
|---|
| 637 | \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
|
|---|
| 638 | }
|
|---|
| 639 |
|
|---|
| 640 | % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
|
|---|
| 641 | \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
|
|---|
| 642 |
|
|---|
| 643 | % @* forces a line break.
|
|---|
| 644 | \def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
|
|---|
| 645 |
|
|---|
| 646 | % @/ allows a line break.
|
|---|
| 647 | \let\/=\allowbreak
|
|---|
| 648 |
|
|---|
| 649 | % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
|
|---|
| 650 | \def\.{.\spacefactor=3000 }
|
|---|
| 651 |
|
|---|
| 652 | % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
|
|---|
| 653 | \def\!{!\spacefactor=3000 }
|
|---|
| 654 |
|
|---|
| 655 | % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
|
|---|
| 656 | \def\?{?\spacefactor=3000 }
|
|---|
| 657 |
|
|---|
| 658 | % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
|
|---|
| 659 | % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
|
|---|
| 660 | % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
|
|---|
| 661 | \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
|
|---|
| 662 |
|
|---|
| 663 | % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
|
|---|
| 664 | % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
|
|---|
| 665 | % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
|
|---|
| 666 | % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
|
|---|
| 667 | % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
|
|---|
| 668 | % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
|
|---|
| 669 | % the text is small, which looks bad.
|
|---|
| 670 | %
|
|---|
| 671 | % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
|
|---|
| 672 | % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
|
|---|
| 673 | % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
|
|---|
| 674 | % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
|
|---|
| 675 | % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
|
|---|
| 676 | % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
|
|---|
| 677 | %
|
|---|
| 678 | \newbox\groupbox
|
|---|
| 679 | \def\vfilllimit{0.7}
|
|---|
| 680 | %
|
|---|
| 681 | \envdef\group{%
|
|---|
| 682 | \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
|
|---|
| 683 | \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
|
|---|
| 684 | \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
|
|---|
| 685 | \fi
|
|---|
| 686 | \startsavinginserts
|
|---|
| 687 | %
|
|---|
| 688 | \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
|
|---|
| 689 | % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
|
|---|
| 690 | % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
|
|---|
| 691 | % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
|
|---|
| 692 | % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
|
|---|
| 693 | % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
|
|---|
| 694 | % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
|
|---|
| 695 | \comment
|
|---|
| 696 | }
|
|---|
| 697 | %
|
|---|
| 698 | % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
|
|---|
| 699 | % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
|
|---|
| 700 | % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
|
|---|
| 701 | % above. But it's pretty close.
|
|---|
| 702 | \def\Egroup{%
|
|---|
| 703 | % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
|
|---|
| 704 | % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
|
|---|
| 705 | \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
|
|---|
| 706 | \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
|
|---|
| 707 | \egroup % End the \vtop.
|
|---|
| 708 | % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
|
|---|
| 709 | \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
|
|---|
| 710 | % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
|
|---|
| 711 | \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
|
|---|
| 712 | % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
|
|---|
| 713 | % group, force a page break.
|
|---|
| 714 | \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
|
|---|
| 715 | \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
|
|---|
| 716 | \page
|
|---|
| 717 | \fi
|
|---|
| 718 | \fi
|
|---|
| 719 | \box\groupbox
|
|---|
| 720 | \prevdepth = \dimen1
|
|---|
| 721 | \checkinserts
|
|---|
| 722 | }
|
|---|
| 723 | %
|
|---|
| 724 | % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
|
|---|
| 725 | % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
|
|---|
| 726 | %
|
|---|
| 727 | \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
|
|---|
| 728 | group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
|
|---|
| 729 | where each line of input produces a line of output.}
|
|---|
| 730 |
|
|---|
| 731 | % @need space-in-mils
|
|---|
| 732 | % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
|
|---|
| 733 |
|
|---|
| 734 | \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
|
|---|
| 735 |
|
|---|
| 736 | % Old definition--didn't work.
|
|---|
| 737 | %\parseargdef\need{\par %
|
|---|
| 738 | %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
|
|---|
| 739 | %% if the depth of the box does not fit.
|
|---|
| 740 | %{\baselineskip=0pt%
|
|---|
| 741 | %\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak
|
|---|
| 742 | %\prevdepth=-1000pt
|
|---|
| 743 | %}}
|
|---|
| 744 |
|
|---|
| 745 | \parseargdef\need{%
|
|---|
| 746 | % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
|
|---|
| 747 | % paragraph.
|
|---|
| 748 | \par
|
|---|
| 749 | %
|
|---|
| 750 | % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
|
|---|
| 751 | \dimen0 = #1\mil
|
|---|
| 752 | \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
|
|---|
| 753 | \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
|
|---|
| 754 | \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
|
|---|
| 755 | %
|
|---|
| 756 | % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
|
|---|
| 757 | % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
|
|---|
| 758 | % And a page break here is fine.
|
|---|
| 759 | \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
|
|---|
| 760 | %
|
|---|
| 761 | % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
|
|---|
| 762 | % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
|
|---|
| 763 | % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
|
|---|
| 764 | % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
|
|---|
| 765 | % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
|
|---|
| 766 | %
|
|---|
| 767 | % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
|
|---|
| 768 | % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
|
|---|
| 769 | % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
|
|---|
| 770 | % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
|
|---|
| 771 | % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
|
|---|
| 772 | % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
|
|---|
| 773 | % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
|
|---|
| 774 | \penalty9999
|
|---|
| 775 | %
|
|---|
| 776 | % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
|
|---|
| 777 | \kern -#1\mil
|
|---|
| 778 | %
|
|---|
| 779 | % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
|
|---|
| 780 | \nobreak
|
|---|
| 781 | \fi
|
|---|
| 782 | }
|
|---|
| 783 |
|
|---|
| 784 | % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
|
|---|
| 785 |
|
|---|
| 786 | \let\br = \par
|
|---|
| 787 |
|
|---|
| 788 | % @page forces the start of a new page.
|
|---|
| 789 | %
|
|---|
| 790 | \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
|
|---|
| 791 |
|
|---|
| 792 | % @exdent text....
|
|---|
| 793 | % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
|
|---|
| 794 |
|
|---|
| 795 | % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
|
|---|
| 796 | % That's how much \exdent should take out.
|
|---|
| 797 | \newskip\exdentamount
|
|---|
| 798 |
|
|---|
| 799 | % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
|
|---|
| 800 | \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
|
|---|
| 801 |
|
|---|
| 802 | % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
|
|---|
| 803 | \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
|
|---|
| 804 | \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
|
|---|
| 805 |
|
|---|
| 806 | % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
|
|---|
| 807 | % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
|
|---|
| 808 | % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'.
|
|---|
| 809 | %
|
|---|
| 810 | \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
|
|---|
| 811 | \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
|
|---|
| 812 | %
|
|---|
| 813 | \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
|
|---|
| 814 | \nobreak
|
|---|
| 815 | \kern-\strutdepth
|
|---|
| 816 | \vtop to \strutdepth{%
|
|---|
| 817 | \baselineskip=\strutdepth
|
|---|
| 818 | \vss
|
|---|
| 819 | % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
|
|---|
| 820 | % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
|
|---|
| 821 | \ifx#1l%
|
|---|
| 822 | \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
|
|---|
| 823 | \else
|
|---|
| 824 | \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
|
|---|
| 825 | \fi
|
|---|
| 826 | \null
|
|---|
| 827 | }%
|
|---|
| 828 | }}
|
|---|
| 829 | \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
|
|---|
| 830 | \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
|
|---|
| 831 | %
|
|---|
| 832 | % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
|
|---|
| 833 | % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
|
|---|
| 834 | % else use TEXT for both).
|
|---|
| 835 | %
|
|---|
| 836 | \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
|
|---|
| 837 | \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
|
|---|
| 838 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
|
|---|
| 839 | \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
|
|---|
| 840 | \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
|
|---|
| 841 | \def\righttext{#2}%
|
|---|
| 842 | \else
|
|---|
| 843 | \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
|
|---|
| 844 | \def\righttext{#1}%
|
|---|
| 845 | \fi
|
|---|
| 846 | %
|
|---|
| 847 | \ifodd\pageno
|
|---|
| 848 | \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
|
|---|
| 849 | \else
|
|---|
| 850 | \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
|
|---|
| 851 | \fi
|
|---|
| 852 | \temp
|
|---|
| 853 | }
|
|---|
| 854 |
|
|---|
| 855 | % @include file insert text of that file as input.
|
|---|
| 856 | %
|
|---|
| 857 | \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
|
|---|
| 858 | \def\includezzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 859 | \pushthisfilestack
|
|---|
| 860 | \def\thisfile{#1}%
|
|---|
| 861 | {%
|
|---|
| 862 | \makevalueexpandable
|
|---|
| 863 | \def\temp{\input #1 }%
|
|---|
| 864 | \expandafter
|
|---|
| 865 | }\temp
|
|---|
| 866 | \popthisfilestack
|
|---|
| 867 | }
|
|---|
| 868 | \def\filenamecatcodes{%
|
|---|
| 869 | \catcode`\\=\other
|
|---|
| 870 | \catcode`~=\other
|
|---|
| 871 | \catcode`^=\other
|
|---|
| 872 | \catcode`_=\other
|
|---|
| 873 | \catcode`|=\other
|
|---|
| 874 | \catcode`<=\other
|
|---|
| 875 | \catcode`>=\other
|
|---|
| 876 | \catcode`+=\other
|
|---|
| 877 | \catcode`-=\other
|
|---|
| 878 | }
|
|---|
| 879 |
|
|---|
| 880 | \def\pushthisfilestack{%
|
|---|
| 881 | \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
|
|---|
| 882 | }
|
|---|
| 883 | \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
|
|---|
| 884 | \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
|
|---|
| 885 | }
|
|---|
| 886 | \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
|
|---|
| 887 | \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
|
|---|
| 888 | }
|
|---|
| 889 |
|
|---|
| 890 | \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
|
|---|
| 891 | \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
|
|---|
| 892 | the stack of filenames is empty.}}
|
|---|
| 893 |
|
|---|
| 894 | \def\thisfile{}
|
|---|
| 895 |
|
|---|
| 896 | % @center line
|
|---|
| 897 | % outputs that line, centered.
|
|---|
| 898 | %
|
|---|
| 899 | \parseargdef\center{%
|
|---|
| 900 | \ifhmode
|
|---|
| 901 | \let\next\centerH
|
|---|
| 902 | \else
|
|---|
| 903 | \let\next\centerV
|
|---|
| 904 | \fi
|
|---|
| 905 | \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
|
|---|
| 906 | }
|
|---|
| 907 | \def\centerH#1{%
|
|---|
| 908 | {%
|
|---|
| 909 | \hfil\break
|
|---|
| 910 | \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
|
|---|
| 911 | \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
|
|---|
| 912 | \line{#1}%
|
|---|
| 913 | \break
|
|---|
| 914 | }%
|
|---|
| 915 | }
|
|---|
| 916 | \def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
|
|---|
| 917 |
|
|---|
| 918 | % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
|
|---|
| 919 |
|
|---|
| 920 | \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
|
|---|
| 921 |
|
|---|
| 922 | % @comment ...line which is ignored...
|
|---|
| 923 | % @c is the same as @comment
|
|---|
| 924 | % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
|
|---|
| 925 |
|
|---|
| 926 | \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other%
|
|---|
| 927 | \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
|
|---|
| 928 | \commentxxx}
|
|---|
| 929 | {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
|
|---|
| 930 |
|
|---|
| 931 | \let\c=\comment
|
|---|
| 932 |
|
|---|
| 933 | % @paragraphindent NCHARS
|
|---|
| 934 | % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
|
|---|
| 935 | % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
|
|---|
| 936 | % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
|
|---|
| 937 | %
|
|---|
| 938 | \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
|
|---|
| 939 | \def\noneword{none}
|
|---|
| 940 | %
|
|---|
| 941 | \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
|
|---|
| 942 | \def\temp{#1}%
|
|---|
| 943 | \ifx\temp\asisword
|
|---|
| 944 | \else
|
|---|
| 945 | \ifx\temp\noneword
|
|---|
| 946 | \defaultparindent = 0pt
|
|---|
| 947 | \else
|
|---|
| 948 | \defaultparindent = #1em
|
|---|
| 949 | \fi
|
|---|
| 950 | \fi
|
|---|
| 951 | \parindent = \defaultparindent
|
|---|
| 952 | }
|
|---|
| 953 |
|
|---|
| 954 | % @exampleindent NCHARS
|
|---|
| 955 | % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
|
|---|
| 956 | % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
|
|---|
| 957 | % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
|
|---|
| 958 | \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
|
|---|
| 959 | \def\temp{#1}%
|
|---|
| 960 | \ifx\temp\asisword
|
|---|
| 961 | \else
|
|---|
| 962 | \ifx\temp\noneword
|
|---|
| 963 | \lispnarrowing = 0pt
|
|---|
| 964 | \else
|
|---|
| 965 | \lispnarrowing = #1em
|
|---|
| 966 | \fi
|
|---|
| 967 | \fi
|
|---|
| 968 | }
|
|---|
| 969 |
|
|---|
| 970 | % @firstparagraphindent WORD
|
|---|
| 971 | % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
|
|---|
| 972 | % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
|
|---|
| 973 | % paragraphs.
|
|---|
| 974 | %
|
|---|
| 975 | % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
|
|---|
| 976 | % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
|
|---|
| 977 | % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
|
|---|
| 978 | % By default, we suppress indentation.
|
|---|
| 979 | %
|
|---|
| 980 | \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
|
|---|
| 981 | \def\insertword{insert}
|
|---|
| 982 | %
|
|---|
| 983 | \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
|
|---|
| 984 | \def\temp{#1}%
|
|---|
| 985 | \ifx\temp\noneword
|
|---|
| 986 | \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
|
|---|
| 987 | \else\ifx\temp\insertword
|
|---|
| 988 | \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
|
|---|
| 989 | \else
|
|---|
| 990 | \errhelp = \EMsimple
|
|---|
| 991 | \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
|
|---|
| 992 | \fi\fi
|
|---|
| 993 | }
|
|---|
| 994 |
|
|---|
| 995 | % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
|
|---|
| 996 | % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
|
|---|
| 997 | %
|
|---|
| 998 | % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
|
|---|
| 999 | % paragraph.
|
|---|
| 1000 | %
|
|---|
| 1001 | \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
|
|---|
| 1002 | \gdef\indent{%
|
|---|
| 1003 | \restorefirstparagraphindent
|
|---|
| 1004 | \indent
|
|---|
| 1005 | }%
|
|---|
| 1006 | \gdef\noindent{%
|
|---|
| 1007 | \restorefirstparagraphindent
|
|---|
| 1008 | \noindent
|
|---|
| 1009 | }%
|
|---|
| 1010 | \global\everypar = {%
|
|---|
| 1011 | \kern -\parindent
|
|---|
| 1012 | \restorefirstparagraphindent
|
|---|
| 1013 | }%
|
|---|
| 1014 | }
|
|---|
| 1015 |
|
|---|
| 1016 | \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
|
|---|
| 1017 | \global \let \indent = \ptexindent
|
|---|
| 1018 | \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent
|
|---|
| 1019 | \global \everypar = {}%
|
|---|
| 1020 | }
|
|---|
| 1021 |
|
|---|
| 1022 |
|
|---|
| 1023 | % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
|
|---|
| 1024 | %
|
|---|
| 1025 | \def\asis#1{#1}
|
|---|
| 1026 |
|
|---|
| 1027 | % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
|
|---|
| 1028 | %
|
|---|
| 1029 | % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
|
|---|
| 1030 | % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
|
|---|
| 1031 | % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
|
|---|
| 1032 | % which is what @var uses.
|
|---|
| 1033 | {
|
|---|
| 1034 | \catcode\underChar = \active
|
|---|
| 1035 | \gdef\mathunderscore{%
|
|---|
| 1036 | \catcode\underChar=\active
|
|---|
| 1037 | \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
|
|---|
| 1038 | }
|
|---|
| 1039 | }
|
|---|
| 1040 | % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
|
|---|
| 1041 | % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
|
|---|
| 1042 | % this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not
|
|---|
| 1043 | % otherwise define @\.
|
|---|
| 1044 | %
|
|---|
| 1045 | % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
|
|---|
| 1046 | \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
|
|---|
| 1047 | %
|
|---|
| 1048 | \def\math{%
|
|---|
| 1049 | \tex
|
|---|
| 1050 | \mathunderscore
|
|---|
| 1051 | \let\\ = \mathbackslash
|
|---|
| 1052 | \mathactive
|
|---|
| 1053 | $\finishmath
|
|---|
| 1054 | }
|
|---|
| 1055 | \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
|
|---|
| 1056 |
|
|---|
| 1057 | % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
|
|---|
| 1058 | % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
|
|---|
| 1059 | % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
|
|---|
| 1060 | %
|
|---|
| 1061 | {
|
|---|
| 1062 | \catcode`^ = \active
|
|---|
| 1063 | \catcode`< = \active
|
|---|
| 1064 | \catcode`> = \active
|
|---|
| 1065 | \catcode`+ = \active
|
|---|
| 1066 | \gdef\mathactive{%
|
|---|
| 1067 | \let^ = \ptexhat
|
|---|
| 1068 | \let< = \ptexless
|
|---|
| 1069 | \let> = \ptexgtr
|
|---|
| 1070 | \let+ = \ptexplus
|
|---|
| 1071 | }
|
|---|
| 1072 | }
|
|---|
| 1073 |
|
|---|
| 1074 | % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above.
|
|---|
| 1075 | \def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$}
|
|---|
| 1076 | \def\minus{$-$}
|
|---|
| 1077 |
|
|---|
| 1078 | % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
|
|---|
| 1079 | % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter
|
|---|
| 1080 | % font as three actual period characters.
|
|---|
| 1081 | %
|
|---|
| 1082 | \def\dots{%
|
|---|
| 1083 | \leavevmode
|
|---|
| 1084 | \hbox to 1.5em{%
|
|---|
| 1085 | \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil
|
|---|
| 1086 | .\hfil.\hfil.%
|
|---|
| 1087 | \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil
|
|---|
| 1088 | }%
|
|---|
| 1089 | }
|
|---|
| 1090 |
|
|---|
| 1091 | % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
|
|---|
| 1092 | %
|
|---|
| 1093 | \def\enddots{%
|
|---|
| 1094 | \dots
|
|---|
| 1095 | \spacefactor=3000
|
|---|
| 1096 | }
|
|---|
| 1097 |
|
|---|
| 1098 | % @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
|
|---|
| 1099 | % Texinfo's parsing.
|
|---|
| 1100 | %
|
|---|
| 1101 | \let\comma = ,
|
|---|
| 1102 |
|
|---|
| 1103 | % @refill is a no-op.
|
|---|
| 1104 | \let\refill=\relax
|
|---|
| 1105 |
|
|---|
| 1106 | % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
|
|---|
| 1107 | % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
|
|---|
| 1108 | % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
|
|---|
| 1109 | %
|
|---|
| 1110 | \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
|
|---|
| 1111 | \let\novalidate = \linksfalse
|
|---|
| 1112 |
|
|---|
| 1113 | % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
|
|---|
| 1114 | % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
|
|---|
| 1115 | % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
|
|---|
| 1116 | \def\setfilename{%
|
|---|
| 1117 | \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
|
|---|
| 1118 | \iflinks
|
|---|
| 1119 | \tryauxfile
|
|---|
| 1120 | % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
|
|---|
| 1121 | \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
|
|---|
| 1122 | \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
|
|---|
| 1123 | \openindices
|
|---|
| 1124 | \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
|
|---|
| 1125 | %
|
|---|
| 1126 | % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
|
|---|
| 1127 | % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
|
|---|
| 1128 | \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
|
|---|
| 1129 | \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
|
|---|
| 1130 | \closein 1
|
|---|
| 1131 | %
|
|---|
| 1132 | \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
|
|---|
| 1133 | }
|
|---|
| 1134 |
|
|---|
| 1135 | % Called from \setfilename.
|
|---|
| 1136 | %
|
|---|
| 1137 | \def\openindices{%
|
|---|
| 1138 | \newindex{cp}%
|
|---|
| 1139 | \newcodeindex{fn}%
|
|---|
| 1140 | \newcodeindex{vr}%
|
|---|
| 1141 | \newcodeindex{tp}%
|
|---|
| 1142 | \newcodeindex{ky}%
|
|---|
| 1143 | \newcodeindex{pg}%
|
|---|
| 1144 | }
|
|---|
| 1145 |
|
|---|
| 1146 | % @bye.
|
|---|
| 1147 | \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
|
|---|
| 1148 |
|
|---|
| 1149 |
|
|---|
| 1150 | \message{pdf,}
|
|---|
| 1151 | % adobe `portable' document format
|
|---|
| 1152 | \newcount\tempnum
|
|---|
| 1153 | \newcount\lnkcount
|
|---|
| 1154 | \newtoks\filename
|
|---|
| 1155 | \newcount\filenamelength
|
|---|
| 1156 | \newcount\pgn
|
|---|
| 1157 | \newtoks\toksA
|
|---|
| 1158 | \newtoks\toksB
|
|---|
| 1159 | \newtoks\toksC
|
|---|
| 1160 | \newtoks\toksD
|
|---|
| 1161 | \newbox\boxA
|
|---|
| 1162 | \newcount\countA
|
|---|
| 1163 | \newif\ifpdf
|
|---|
| 1164 | \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
|
|---|
| 1165 |
|
|---|
| 1166 | % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
|
|---|
| 1167 | % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
|
|---|
| 1168 | % borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
|
|---|
| 1169 | \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
|
|---|
| 1170 | \else
|
|---|
| 1171 | \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
|
|---|
| 1172 | \else
|
|---|
| 1173 | \ifcase\pdfoutput
|
|---|
| 1174 | \else
|
|---|
| 1175 | \pdftrue
|
|---|
| 1176 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1177 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1178 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1179 | %
|
|---|
| 1180 | \ifpdf
|
|---|
| 1181 | \input pdfcolor
|
|---|
| 1182 | \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}%
|
|---|
| 1183 | \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
|
|---|
| 1184 | \def\imagewidth{#2}%
|
|---|
| 1185 | \def\imageheight{#3}%
|
|---|
| 1186 | % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is
|
|---|
| 1187 | % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
|
|---|
| 1188 | \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
|
|---|
| 1189 | \immediate\pdfimage
|
|---|
| 1190 | \else
|
|---|
| 1191 | \immediate\pdfximage
|
|---|
| 1192 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1193 | \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi
|
|---|
| 1194 | \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi
|
|---|
| 1195 | \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
|
|---|
| 1196 | #1.pdf%
|
|---|
| 1197 | \else
|
|---|
| 1198 | {#1.pdf}%
|
|---|
| 1199 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1200 | \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
|
|---|
| 1201 | \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
|
|---|
| 1202 | \fi}
|
|---|
| 1203 | \def\pdfmkdest#1{{%
|
|---|
| 1204 | % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code in a section title
|
|---|
| 1205 | % aren't expanded.
|
|---|
| 1206 | \atdummies
|
|---|
| 1207 | \normalturnoffactive
|
|---|
| 1208 | \pdfdest name{#1} xyz%
|
|---|
| 1209 | }}
|
|---|
| 1210 | \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
|
|---|
| 1211 | \let\linkcolor = \Blue % was Cyan, but that seems light?
|
|---|
| 1212 | \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink}
|
|---|
| 1213 | % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
|
|---|
| 1214 | % come from Petr Olsak
|
|---|
| 1215 | \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
|
|---|
| 1216 | \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
|
|---|
| 1217 | \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
|
|---|
| 1218 | \advance\tempnum by 1
|
|---|
| 1219 | \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
|
|---|
| 1220 | %
|
|---|
| 1221 | % #1 is the section text. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
|
|---|
| 1222 | % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node
|
|---|
| 1223 | % text, which might be empty if this toc entry had no
|
|---|
| 1224 | % corresponding node. #4 is the page number.
|
|---|
| 1225 | %
|
|---|
| 1226 | \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
|
|---|
| 1227 | % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
|
|---|
| 1228 | % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
|
|---|
| 1229 | % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
|
|---|
| 1230 | % seem worthwhile, since most documents are normally structured.
|
|---|
| 1231 | \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
|
|---|
| 1232 | \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}\fi
|
|---|
| 1233 | %
|
|---|
| 1234 | \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{#1}%
|
|---|
| 1235 | }
|
|---|
| 1236 | %
|
|---|
| 1237 | \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
|
|---|
| 1238 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 1239 | % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
|
|---|
| 1240 | \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace
|
|---|
| 1241 | \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace
|
|---|
| 1242 | %
|
|---|
| 1243 | % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
|
|---|
| 1244 | \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
|
|---|
| 1245 | \def\thischapnum{##2}%
|
|---|
| 1246 | \def\thissecnum{0}%
|
|---|
| 1247 | \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
|
|---|
| 1248 | }%
|
|---|
| 1249 | \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
|
|---|
| 1250 | \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
|
|---|
| 1251 | \def\thissecnum{##2}%
|
|---|
| 1252 | \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
|
|---|
| 1253 | }%
|
|---|
| 1254 | \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
|
|---|
| 1255 | \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
|
|---|
| 1256 | \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
|
|---|
| 1257 | }%
|
|---|
| 1258 | \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
|
|---|
| 1259 | \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
|
|---|
| 1260 | }%
|
|---|
| 1261 | \def\thischapnum{0}%
|
|---|
| 1262 | \def\thissecnum{0}%
|
|---|
| 1263 | \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
|
|---|
| 1264 | %
|
|---|
| 1265 | % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
|
|---|
| 1266 | % al. a second time, below.
|
|---|
| 1267 | \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
|
|---|
| 1268 | \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
|
|---|
| 1269 | \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
|
|---|
| 1270 | \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
|
|---|
| 1271 | \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
|
|---|
| 1272 | \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
|
|---|
| 1273 | \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
|
|---|
| 1274 | \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
|
|---|
| 1275 | \input \jobname.toc
|
|---|
| 1276 | %
|
|---|
| 1277 | % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
|
|---|
| 1278 | % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
|
|---|
| 1279 | % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
|
|---|
| 1280 | %
|
|---|
| 1281 | % We use the node names as the destinations.
|
|---|
| 1282 | \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
|
|---|
| 1283 | \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
|
|---|
| 1284 | \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
|
|---|
| 1285 | \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
|
|---|
| 1286 | \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
|
|---|
| 1287 | \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
|
|---|
| 1288 | \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
|
|---|
| 1289 | \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
|
|---|
| 1290 | %
|
|---|
| 1291 | % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
|
|---|
| 1292 | % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
|
|---|
| 1293 | % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
|
|---|
| 1294 | % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
|
|---|
| 1295 | % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
|
|---|
| 1296 | %
|
|---|
| 1297 | % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
|
|---|
| 1298 | % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right
|
|---|
| 1299 | % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
|
|---|
| 1300 | \indexnofonts
|
|---|
| 1301 | \turnoffactive
|
|---|
| 1302 | \input \jobname.toc
|
|---|
| 1303 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 1304 | }
|
|---|
| 1305 | %
|
|---|
| 1306 | \def\makelinks #1,{%
|
|---|
| 1307 | \def\params{#1}\def\E{END}%
|
|---|
| 1308 | \ifx\params\E
|
|---|
| 1309 | \let\nextmakelinks=\relax
|
|---|
| 1310 | \else
|
|---|
| 1311 | \let\nextmakelinks=\makelinks
|
|---|
| 1312 | \ifnum\lnkcount>0,\fi
|
|---|
| 1313 | \picknum{#1}%
|
|---|
| 1314 | \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}
|
|---|
| 1315 | goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\the\pgn}}%
|
|---|
| 1316 | \linkcolor #1%
|
|---|
| 1317 | \advance\lnkcount by 1%
|
|---|
| 1318 | \endlink
|
|---|
| 1319 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1320 | \nextmakelinks
|
|---|
| 1321 | }
|
|---|
| 1322 | \def\picknum#1{\expandafter\pn#1}
|
|---|
| 1323 | \def\pn#1{%
|
|---|
| 1324 | \def\p{#1}%
|
|---|
| 1325 | \ifx\p\lbrace
|
|---|
| 1326 | \let\nextpn=\ppn
|
|---|
| 1327 | \else
|
|---|
| 1328 | \let\nextpn=\ppnn
|
|---|
| 1329 | \def\first{#1}
|
|---|
| 1330 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1331 | \nextpn
|
|---|
| 1332 | }
|
|---|
| 1333 | \def\ppn#1{\pgn=#1\gobble}
|
|---|
| 1334 | \def\ppnn{\pgn=\first}
|
|---|
| 1335 | \def\pdfmklnk#1{\lnkcount=0\makelinks #1,END,}
|
|---|
| 1336 | \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
|
|---|
| 1337 | \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
|
|---|
| 1338 | \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
|
|---|
| 1339 | \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
|
|---|
| 1340 | \advance\filenamelength by 1
|
|---|
| 1341 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1342 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1343 | \nextsp}
|
|---|
| 1344 | \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax}
|
|---|
| 1345 | \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
|
|---|
| 1346 | \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
|
|---|
| 1347 | \else
|
|---|
| 1348 | \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
|
|---|
| 1349 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1350 | \def\pdfurl#1{%
|
|---|
| 1351 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 1352 | \normalturnoffactive\def\@{@}%
|
|---|
| 1353 | \makevalueexpandable
|
|---|
| 1354 | \leavevmode\Red
|
|---|
| 1355 | \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
|
|---|
| 1356 | user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
|
|---|
| 1357 | \endgroup}
|
|---|
| 1358 | \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
|
|---|
| 1359 | \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
|
|---|
| 1360 | \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
|
|---|
| 1361 | \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
|
|---|
| 1362 | \def\maketoks{%
|
|---|
| 1363 | \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
|
|---|
| 1364 | \ifx\first0\adn0
|
|---|
| 1365 | \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
|
|---|
| 1366 | \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
|
|---|
| 1367 | \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
|
|---|
| 1368 | \else
|
|---|
| 1369 | \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
|
|---|
| 1370 | \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
|
|---|
| 1371 | \let\next=\maketoks
|
|---|
| 1372 | \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
|
|---|
| 1373 | \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
|
|---|
| 1374 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1375 | \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
|
|---|
| 1376 | \next}
|
|---|
| 1377 | \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
|
|---|
| 1378 | {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
|
|---|
| 1379 | \def\pdflink#1{%
|
|---|
| 1380 | \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
|
|---|
| 1381 | \linkcolor #1\endlink}
|
|---|
| 1382 | \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
|
|---|
| 1383 | \else
|
|---|
| 1384 | \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
|
|---|
| 1385 | \let\pdfurl = \gobble
|
|---|
| 1386 | \let\endlink = \relax
|
|---|
| 1387 | \let\linkcolor = \relax
|
|---|
| 1388 | \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
|
|---|
| 1389 | \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
|
|---|
| 1390 |
|
|---|
| 1391 |
|
|---|
| 1392 | \message{fonts,}
|
|---|
| 1393 |
|
|---|
| 1394 | % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
|
|---|
| 1395 | % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
|
|---|
| 1396 | % italics, not bold italics.
|
|---|
| 1397 | %
|
|---|
| 1398 | \def\setfontstyle#1{%
|
|---|
| 1399 | \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
|
|---|
| 1400 | \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font
|
|---|
| 1401 | }
|
|---|
| 1402 |
|
|---|
| 1403 | % Select #1 fonts with the current style.
|
|---|
| 1404 | %
|
|---|
| 1405 | \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
|
|---|
| 1406 |
|
|---|
| 1407 | \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
|
|---|
| 1408 | \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
|
|---|
| 1409 | \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
|
|---|
| 1410 | \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
|
|---|
| 1411 | \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
|
|---|
| 1412 |
|
|---|
| 1413 | % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
|
|---|
| 1414 | % So we set up a \sf.
|
|---|
| 1415 | \newfam\sffam
|
|---|
| 1416 | \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
|
|---|
| 1417 | \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
|
|---|
| 1418 |
|
|---|
| 1419 | % We don't need math for this font style.
|
|---|
| 1420 | \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
|
|---|
| 1421 |
|
|---|
| 1422 | % Default leading.
|
|---|
| 1423 | \newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt
|
|---|
| 1424 |
|
|---|
| 1425 | % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
|
|---|
| 1426 | % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
|
|---|
| 1427 | % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
|
|---|
| 1428 | %
|
|---|
| 1429 | \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
|
|---|
| 1430 | \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
|
|---|
| 1431 | \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
|
|---|
| 1432 | %
|
|---|
| 1433 | \def\setleading#1{%
|
|---|
| 1434 | \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax
|
|---|
| 1435 | \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
|
|---|
| 1436 | \normalbaselines
|
|---|
| 1437 | \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
|
|---|
| 1438 | \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 1439 | depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
|
|---|
| 1440 | }%
|
|---|
| 1441 | }
|
|---|
| 1442 |
|
|---|
| 1443 | % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
|
|---|
| 1444 | % specified font prefix (normally `cm').
|
|---|
| 1445 | % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor
|
|---|
| 1446 | \def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4}
|
|---|
| 1447 |
|
|---|
| 1448 | % Use cm as the default font prefix.
|
|---|
| 1449 | % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
|
|---|
| 1450 | % before you read in texinfo.tex.
|
|---|
| 1451 | \ifx\fontprefix\undefined
|
|---|
| 1452 | \def\fontprefix{cm}
|
|---|
| 1453 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1454 | % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
|
|---|
| 1455 | \def\rmshape{r}
|
|---|
| 1456 | \def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold
|
|---|
| 1457 | \def\bfshape{b}
|
|---|
| 1458 | \def\bxshape{bx}
|
|---|
| 1459 | \def\ttshape{tt}
|
|---|
| 1460 | \def\ttbshape{tt}
|
|---|
| 1461 | \def\ttslshape{sltt}
|
|---|
| 1462 | \def\itshape{ti}
|
|---|
| 1463 | \def\itbshape{bxti}
|
|---|
| 1464 | \def\slshape{sl}
|
|---|
| 1465 | \def\slbshape{bxsl}
|
|---|
| 1466 | \def\sfshape{ss}
|
|---|
| 1467 | \def\sfbshape{ss}
|
|---|
| 1468 | \def\scshape{csc}
|
|---|
| 1469 | \def\scbshape{csc}
|
|---|
| 1470 |
|
|---|
| 1471 | % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
|
|---|
| 1472 | \def\textnominalsize{11pt}
|
|---|
| 1473 | \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
|
|---|
| 1474 | \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
|
|---|
| 1475 | \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
|
|---|
| 1476 | \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
|
|---|
| 1477 | \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
|
|---|
| 1478 | \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
|
|---|
| 1479 | \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
|
|---|
| 1480 | \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
|
|---|
| 1481 | \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
|
|---|
| 1482 | \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
|
|---|
| 1483 | \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
|
|---|
| 1484 |
|
|---|
| 1485 | % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
|
|---|
| 1486 | \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}
|
|---|
| 1487 | \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}
|
|---|
| 1488 | \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}
|
|---|
| 1489 | \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
|
|---|
| 1490 |
|
|---|
| 1491 | % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
|
|---|
| 1492 | \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
|
|---|
| 1493 | \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1494 | \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1495 | \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}
|
|---|
| 1496 | \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1497 | \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1498 | \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1499 | \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}
|
|---|
| 1500 | \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}
|
|---|
| 1501 | \font\smalli=cmmi9
|
|---|
| 1502 | \font\smallsy=cmsy9
|
|---|
| 1503 |
|
|---|
| 1504 | % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
|
|---|
| 1505 | \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
|
|---|
| 1506 | \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1507 | \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1508 | \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}
|
|---|
| 1509 | \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1510 | \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1511 | \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1512 | \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}
|
|---|
| 1513 | \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}
|
|---|
| 1514 | \font\smalleri=cmmi8
|
|---|
| 1515 | \font\smallersy=cmsy8
|
|---|
| 1516 |
|
|---|
| 1517 | % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
|
|---|
| 1518 | \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
|
|---|
| 1519 | \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}
|
|---|
| 1520 | \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}
|
|---|
| 1521 | \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}
|
|---|
| 1522 | \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}
|
|---|
| 1523 | \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}
|
|---|
| 1524 | \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}
|
|---|
| 1525 | \let\titlebf=\titlerm
|
|---|
| 1526 | \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}
|
|---|
| 1527 | \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
|
|---|
| 1528 | \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
|
|---|
| 1529 | \def\authorrm{\secrm}
|
|---|
| 1530 | \def\authortt{\sectt}
|
|---|
| 1531 |
|
|---|
| 1532 | % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
|
|---|
| 1533 | \def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
|
|---|
| 1534 | \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}
|
|---|
| 1535 | \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}
|
|---|
| 1536 | \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}
|
|---|
| 1537 | \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}
|
|---|
| 1538 | \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}
|
|---|
| 1539 | \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1540 | \let\chapbf=\chaprm
|
|---|
| 1541 | \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}
|
|---|
| 1542 | \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
|
|---|
| 1543 | \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
|
|---|
| 1544 |
|
|---|
| 1545 | % Section fonts (14.4pt).
|
|---|
| 1546 | \def\secnominalsize{14pt}
|
|---|
| 1547 | \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}
|
|---|
| 1548 | \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}
|
|---|
| 1549 | \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}
|
|---|
| 1550 | \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}
|
|---|
| 1551 | \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}
|
|---|
| 1552 | \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}
|
|---|
| 1553 | \let\secbf\secrm
|
|---|
| 1554 | \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}
|
|---|
| 1555 | \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
|
|---|
| 1556 | \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
|
|---|
| 1557 |
|
|---|
| 1558 | % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
|
|---|
| 1559 | \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
|
|---|
| 1560 | \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
|
|---|
| 1561 | \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}
|
|---|
| 1562 | \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}
|
|---|
| 1563 | \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
|
|---|
| 1564 | \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}
|
|---|
| 1565 | \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
|
|---|
| 1566 | \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
|
|---|
| 1567 | \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}
|
|---|
| 1568 | \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
|
|---|
| 1569 | \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
|
|---|
| 1570 |
|
|---|
| 1571 | % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
|
|---|
| 1572 | \def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
|
|---|
| 1573 | \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1574 | \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1575 | \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1576 | \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1577 | \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1578 | \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1579 | \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1580 | \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1581 | \font\reducedi=cmmi10
|
|---|
| 1582 | \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
|
|---|
| 1583 |
|
|---|
| 1584 | % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
|
|---|
| 1585 | % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
|
|---|
| 1586 | % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
|
|---|
| 1587 | % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
|
|---|
| 1588 | % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
|
|---|
| 1589 | %
|
|---|
| 1590 | \def\resetmathfonts{%
|
|---|
| 1591 | \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy
|
|---|
| 1592 | \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf
|
|---|
| 1593 | \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf
|
|---|
| 1594 | }
|
|---|
| 1595 |
|
|---|
| 1596 | % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
|
|---|
| 1597 | % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
|
|---|
| 1598 | % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
|
|---|
| 1599 | % \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
|
|---|
| 1600 | %
|
|---|
| 1601 | % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
|
|---|
| 1602 | % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
|
|---|
| 1603 | % the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
|
|---|
| 1604 | %
|
|---|
| 1605 | % This all needs generalizing, badly.
|
|---|
| 1606 | %
|
|---|
| 1607 | \def\textfonts{%
|
|---|
| 1608 | \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
|
|---|
| 1609 | \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
|
|---|
| 1610 | \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
|
|---|
| 1611 | \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
|
|---|
| 1612 | \def\curfontsize{text}%
|
|---|
| 1613 | \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
|
|---|
| 1614 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
|
|---|
| 1615 | \def\titlefonts{%
|
|---|
| 1616 | \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl
|
|---|
| 1617 | \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc
|
|---|
| 1618 | \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy
|
|---|
| 1619 | \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
|
|---|
| 1620 | \def\curfontsize{title}%
|
|---|
| 1621 | \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
|
|---|
| 1622 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}}
|
|---|
| 1623 | \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
|
|---|
| 1624 | \def\chapfonts{%
|
|---|
| 1625 | \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
|
|---|
| 1626 | \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
|
|---|
| 1627 | \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
|
|---|
| 1628 | \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
|
|---|
| 1629 | \def\curfontsize{chap}%
|
|---|
| 1630 | \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}%
|
|---|
| 1631 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}}
|
|---|
| 1632 | \def\secfonts{%
|
|---|
| 1633 | \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
|
|---|
| 1634 | \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
|
|---|
| 1635 | \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
|
|---|
| 1636 | \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
|
|---|
| 1637 | \def\curfontsize{sec}%
|
|---|
| 1638 | \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
|
|---|
| 1639 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}}
|
|---|
| 1640 | \def\subsecfonts{%
|
|---|
| 1641 | \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
|
|---|
| 1642 | \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
|
|---|
| 1643 | \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
|
|---|
| 1644 | \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
|
|---|
| 1645 | \def\curfontsize{ssec}%
|
|---|
| 1646 | \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}%
|
|---|
| 1647 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}}
|
|---|
| 1648 | \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts
|
|---|
| 1649 | \def\reducedfonts{%
|
|---|
| 1650 | \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl
|
|---|
| 1651 | \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc
|
|---|
| 1652 | \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy
|
|---|
| 1653 | \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl
|
|---|
| 1654 | \def\curfontsize{reduced}%
|
|---|
| 1655 | \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
|
|---|
| 1656 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
|
|---|
| 1657 | \def\smallfonts{%
|
|---|
| 1658 | \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl
|
|---|
| 1659 | \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc
|
|---|
| 1660 | \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy
|
|---|
| 1661 | \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl
|
|---|
| 1662 | \def\curfontsize{small}%
|
|---|
| 1663 | \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
|
|---|
| 1664 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
|
|---|
| 1665 | \def\smallerfonts{%
|
|---|
| 1666 | \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl
|
|---|
| 1667 | \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc
|
|---|
| 1668 | \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy
|
|---|
| 1669 | \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl
|
|---|
| 1670 | \def\curfontsize{smaller}%
|
|---|
| 1671 | \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
|
|---|
| 1672 | \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
|
|---|
| 1673 |
|
|---|
| 1674 | % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
|
|---|
| 1675 | \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
|
|---|
| 1676 |
|
|---|
| 1677 | % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
|
|---|
| 1678 | % can fit this many characters:
|
|---|
| 1679 | % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
|
|---|
| 1680 | % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
|
|---|
| 1681 | % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
|
|---|
| 1682 | % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
|
|---|
| 1683 | % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
|
|---|
| 1684 | %
|
|---|
| 1685 | % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
|
|---|
| 1686 | % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
|
|---|
| 1687 | %
|
|---|
| 1688 | % I wish the USA used A4 paper.
|
|---|
| 1689 | % --karl, 24jan03.
|
|---|
| 1690 |
|
|---|
| 1691 |
|
|---|
| 1692 | % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
|
|---|
| 1693 | %
|
|---|
| 1694 | \textfonts \rm
|
|---|
| 1695 |
|
|---|
| 1696 | % Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
|
|---|
| 1697 | \def\angleleft{$\langle$}
|
|---|
| 1698 | \def\angleright{$\rangle$}
|
|---|
| 1699 |
|
|---|
| 1700 | % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
|
|---|
| 1701 | \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
|
|---|
| 1702 |
|
|---|
| 1703 | % Fonts for short table of contents.
|
|---|
| 1704 | \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1705 | \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1} % no cmb12
|
|---|
| 1706 | \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1707 | \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1708 |
|
|---|
| 1709 | %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
|
|---|
| 1710 | %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
|
|---|
| 1711 |
|
|---|
| 1712 | % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
|
|---|
| 1713 | % unless the following character is such as not to need one.
|
|---|
| 1714 | \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else
|
|---|
| 1715 | \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi}
|
|---|
| 1716 | \def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
|
|---|
| 1717 | \def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
|
|---|
| 1718 |
|
|---|
| 1719 | % like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
|
|---|
| 1720 | % @var is set to this for defun arguments.
|
|---|
| 1721 | \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
|
|---|
| 1722 |
|
|---|
| 1723 | % like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
|
|---|
| 1724 | % ttsl for book titles, do we?
|
|---|
| 1725 | \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
|
|---|
| 1726 |
|
|---|
| 1727 | \let\i=\smartitalic
|
|---|
| 1728 | \let\slanted=\smartslanted
|
|---|
| 1729 | \let\var=\smartslanted
|
|---|
| 1730 | \let\dfn=\smartslanted
|
|---|
| 1731 | \let\emph=\smartitalic
|
|---|
| 1732 |
|
|---|
| 1733 | % @b, explicit bold.
|
|---|
| 1734 | \def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
|
|---|
| 1735 | \let\strong=\b
|
|---|
| 1736 |
|
|---|
| 1737 | % @sansserif, explicit sans.
|
|---|
| 1738 | \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
|
|---|
| 1739 |
|
|---|
| 1740 | % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
|
|---|
| 1741 | % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
|
|---|
| 1742 | % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
|
|---|
| 1743 | %
|
|---|
| 1744 | \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
|
|---|
| 1745 | \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
|
|---|
| 1746 |
|
|---|
| 1747 | % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
|
|---|
| 1748 | % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
|
|---|
| 1749 | % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
|
|---|
| 1750 | %
|
|---|
| 1751 | \catcode`@=11
|
|---|
| 1752 | \def\frenchspacing{%
|
|---|
| 1753 | \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
|
|---|
| 1754 | \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m
|
|---|
| 1755 | }
|
|---|
| 1756 | \catcode`@=\other
|
|---|
| 1757 |
|
|---|
| 1758 | \def\t#1{%
|
|---|
| 1759 | {\tt \rawbackslash \frenchspacing #1}%
|
|---|
| 1760 | \null
|
|---|
| 1761 | }
|
|---|
| 1762 | \def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null}
|
|---|
| 1763 | \setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
|
|---|
| 1764 | \font\keysy=cmsy9
|
|---|
| 1765 | \def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
|
|---|
| 1766 | \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
|
|---|
| 1767 | \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
|
|---|
| 1768 | \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
|
|---|
| 1769 | \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
|
|---|
| 1770 | \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
|
|---|
| 1771 | % The old definition, with no lozenge:
|
|---|
| 1772 | %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
|
|---|
| 1773 | \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
|
|---|
| 1774 |
|
|---|
| 1775 | % @file, @option are the same as @samp.
|
|---|
| 1776 | \let\file=\samp
|
|---|
| 1777 | \let\option=\samp
|
|---|
| 1778 |
|
|---|
| 1779 | % @code is a modification of @t,
|
|---|
| 1780 | % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
|
|---|
| 1781 | \def\tclose#1{%
|
|---|
| 1782 | {%
|
|---|
| 1783 | % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
|
|---|
| 1784 | \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
|
|---|
| 1785 | %
|
|---|
| 1786 | % Switch to typewriter.
|
|---|
| 1787 | \tt
|
|---|
| 1788 | %
|
|---|
| 1789 | % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
|
|---|
| 1790 | \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
|
|---|
| 1791 | %
|
|---|
| 1792 | % Turn off hyphenation.
|
|---|
| 1793 | \nohyphenation
|
|---|
| 1794 | %
|
|---|
| 1795 | \rawbackslash
|
|---|
| 1796 | \frenchspacing
|
|---|
| 1797 | #1%
|
|---|
| 1798 | }%
|
|---|
| 1799 | \null
|
|---|
| 1800 | }
|
|---|
| 1801 |
|
|---|
| 1802 | % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
|
|---|
| 1803 | % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
|
|---|
| 1804 | % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
|
|---|
| 1805 |
|
|---|
| 1806 | % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
|
|---|
| 1807 | % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
|
|---|
| 1808 | % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
|
|---|
| 1809 | % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
|
|---|
| 1810 | % -- rms.
|
|---|
| 1811 | {
|
|---|
| 1812 | \catcode`\-=\active
|
|---|
| 1813 | \catcode`\_=\active
|
|---|
| 1814 | %
|
|---|
| 1815 | \global\def\code{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 1816 | \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash
|
|---|
| 1817 | \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder
|
|---|
| 1818 | \codex
|
|---|
| 1819 | }
|
|---|
| 1820 | }
|
|---|
| 1821 |
|
|---|
| 1822 | \def\realdash{-}
|
|---|
| 1823 | \def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}}
|
|---|
| 1824 | \def\codeunder{%
|
|---|
| 1825 | % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
|
|---|
| 1826 | % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
|
|---|
| 1827 | % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
|
|---|
| 1828 | % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
|
|---|
| 1829 | \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
|
|---|
| 1830 | \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
|
|---|
| 1831 | \else\normalunderscore \fi
|
|---|
| 1832 | \discretionary{}{}{}}%
|
|---|
| 1833 | {\_}%
|
|---|
| 1834 | }
|
|---|
| 1835 | \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
|
|---|
| 1836 |
|
|---|
| 1837 | % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
|
|---|
| 1838 | % then @kbd has no effect.
|
|---|
| 1839 |
|
|---|
| 1840 | % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
|
|---|
| 1841 | % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
|
|---|
| 1842 | % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
|
|---|
| 1843 | \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
|
|---|
| 1844 | \def\arg{#1}%
|
|---|
| 1845 | \ifx\arg\worddistinct
|
|---|
| 1846 | \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
|
|---|
| 1847 | \else\ifx\arg\wordexample
|
|---|
| 1848 | \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
|
|---|
| 1849 | \else\ifx\arg\wordcode
|
|---|
| 1850 | \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
|
|---|
| 1851 | \else
|
|---|
| 1852 | \errhelp = \EMsimple
|
|---|
| 1853 | \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\arg'}%
|
|---|
| 1854 | \fi\fi\fi
|
|---|
| 1855 | }
|
|---|
| 1856 | \def\worddistinct{distinct}
|
|---|
| 1857 | \def\wordexample{example}
|
|---|
| 1858 | \def\wordcode{code}
|
|---|
| 1859 |
|
|---|
| 1860 | % Default is `distinct.'
|
|---|
| 1861 | \kbdinputstyle distinct
|
|---|
| 1862 |
|
|---|
| 1863 | \def\xkey{\key}
|
|---|
| 1864 | \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
|
|---|
| 1865 | \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
|
|---|
| 1866 | \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi
|
|---|
| 1867 | \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi}
|
|---|
| 1868 |
|
|---|
| 1869 | % For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
|
|---|
| 1870 | \let\indicateurl=\code
|
|---|
| 1871 | \let\env=\code
|
|---|
| 1872 | \let\command=\code
|
|---|
| 1873 |
|
|---|
| 1874 | % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
|
|---|
| 1875 | % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
|
|---|
| 1876 | % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url
|
|---|
| 1877 | % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in
|
|---|
| 1878 | % a hypertex \special here.
|
|---|
| 1879 | %
|
|---|
| 1880 | \def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish}
|
|---|
| 1881 | \def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 1882 | \unsepspaces
|
|---|
| 1883 | \pdfurl{#1}%
|
|---|
| 1884 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
|
|---|
| 1885 | \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
|
|---|
| 1886 | \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
|
|---|
| 1887 | \else
|
|---|
| 1888 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
|
|---|
| 1889 | \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
|
|---|
| 1890 | \ifpdf
|
|---|
| 1891 | \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
|
|---|
| 1892 | \else
|
|---|
| 1893 | \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
|
|---|
| 1894 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1895 | \else
|
|---|
| 1896 | \code{#1}% only url given, so show it
|
|---|
| 1897 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1898 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1899 | \endlink
|
|---|
| 1900 | \endgroup}
|
|---|
| 1901 |
|
|---|
| 1902 | % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
|
|---|
| 1903 | %
|
|---|
| 1904 | \let\url=\uref
|
|---|
| 1905 |
|
|---|
| 1906 | % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
|
|---|
| 1907 | % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
|
|---|
| 1908 | %
|
|---|
| 1909 | %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
|
|---|
| 1910 | \ifpdf
|
|---|
| 1911 | \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
|
|---|
| 1912 | \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 1913 | \unsepspaces
|
|---|
| 1914 | \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
|
|---|
| 1915 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
|
|---|
| 1916 | \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
|
|---|
| 1917 | \endlink
|
|---|
| 1918 | \endgroup}
|
|---|
| 1919 | \else
|
|---|
| 1920 | \let\email=\uref
|
|---|
| 1921 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1922 |
|
|---|
| 1923 | % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
|
|---|
| 1924 | % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
|
|---|
| 1925 | % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
|
|---|
| 1926 | % this property, we can check that font parameter.
|
|---|
| 1927 | %
|
|---|
| 1928 | \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
|
|---|
| 1929 |
|
|---|
| 1930 | % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
|
|---|
| 1931 | % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
|
|---|
| 1932 | %
|
|---|
| 1933 | \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
|
|---|
| 1934 |
|
|---|
| 1935 | \def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par}
|
|---|
| 1936 |
|
|---|
| 1937 | % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
|
|---|
| 1938 | % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
|
|---|
| 1939 | % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
|
|---|
| 1940 | %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
|
|---|
| 1941 |
|
|---|
| 1942 | % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
|
|---|
| 1943 | \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
|
|---|
| 1944 | \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
|
|---|
| 1945 | \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
|
|---|
| 1946 |
|
|---|
| 1947 | % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
|
|---|
| 1948 | % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
|
|---|
| 1949 | % all-uppercase.
|
|---|
| 1950 | %
|
|---|
| 1951 | \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
|
|---|
| 1952 | \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
|
|---|
| 1953 | {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
|
|---|
| 1954 | \def\temp{#2}%
|
|---|
| 1955 | \ifx\temp\empty \else
|
|---|
| 1956 | \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
|
|---|
| 1957 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1958 | }
|
|---|
| 1959 |
|
|---|
| 1960 | % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
|
|---|
| 1961 | % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
|
|---|
| 1962 | %
|
|---|
| 1963 | \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
|
|---|
| 1964 | \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
|
|---|
| 1965 | {\frenchspacing #1}%
|
|---|
| 1966 | \def\temp{#2}%
|
|---|
| 1967 | \ifx\temp\empty \else
|
|---|
| 1968 | \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
|
|---|
| 1969 | \fi
|
|---|
| 1970 | }
|
|---|
| 1971 |
|
|---|
| 1972 | % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
|
|---|
| 1973 | %
|
|---|
| 1974 | \def\pounds{{\it\$}}
|
|---|
| 1975 |
|
|---|
| 1976 | % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
|
|---|
| 1977 | % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
|
|---|
| 1978 | % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
|
|---|
| 1979 | % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
|
|---|
| 1980 | % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
|
|---|
| 1981 | %
|
|---|
| 1982 | % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
|
|---|
| 1983 | % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
|
|---|
| 1984 | % font height.
|
|---|
| 1985 | %
|
|---|
| 1986 | % feymr - regular
|
|---|
| 1987 | % feymo - slanted
|
|---|
| 1988 | % feybr - bold
|
|---|
| 1989 | % feybo - bold slanted
|
|---|
| 1990 | %
|
|---|
| 1991 | % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
|
|---|
| 1992 | % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
|
|---|
| 1993 | % Hmm.
|
|---|
| 1994 | %
|
|---|
| 1995 | % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
|
|---|
| 1996 | % Hope not.
|
|---|
| 1997 | %
|
|---|
| 1998 | %
|
|---|
| 1999 | \def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
|
|---|
| 2000 | \def\eurofont{%
|
|---|
| 2001 | % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
|
|---|
| 2002 | % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
|
|---|
| 2003 | % installations which never need the symbold don't have to have the
|
|---|
| 2004 | % font installed.
|
|---|
| 2005 | %
|
|---|
| 2006 | % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
|
|---|
| 2007 | % that to the current nominal size.
|
|---|
| 2008 | %
|
|---|
| 2009 | % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
|
|---|
| 2010 | % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
|
|---|
| 2011 | %
|
|---|
| 2012 | \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
|
|---|
| 2013 | %
|
|---|
| 2014 | \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
|
|---|
| 2015 | % bold:
|
|---|
| 2016 | \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
|
|---|
| 2017 | \else
|
|---|
| 2018 | % regular:
|
|---|
| 2019 | \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
|
|---|
| 2020 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2021 | \thiseurofont
|
|---|
| 2022 | }
|
|---|
| 2023 |
|
|---|
| 2024 | % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
|
|---|
| 2025 | % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
|
|---|
| 2026 | % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
|
|---|
| 2027 | %
|
|---|
| 2028 | \def\registeredsymbol{%
|
|---|
| 2029 | $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}%
|
|---|
| 2030 | \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
|
|---|
| 2031 | }$%
|
|---|
| 2032 | }
|
|---|
| 2033 |
|
|---|
| 2034 | % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
|
|---|
| 2035 | % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
|
|---|
| 2036 | % so we'll define it if necessary.
|
|---|
| 2037 | %
|
|---|
| 2038 | \ifx\Orb\undefined
|
|---|
| 2039 | \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
|
|---|
| 2040 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2041 |
|
|---|
| 2042 |
|
|---|
| 2043 | \message{page headings,}
|
|---|
| 2044 |
|
|---|
| 2045 | \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
|
|---|
| 2046 | \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
|
|---|
| 2047 |
|
|---|
| 2048 | % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
|
|---|
| 2049 | \newif\ifseenauthor
|
|---|
| 2050 | \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
|
|---|
| 2051 |
|
|---|
| 2052 | % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
|
|---|
| 2053 | % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
|
|---|
| 2054 | %
|
|---|
| 2055 | \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
|
|---|
| 2056 | \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
|
|---|
| 2057 | \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
|
|---|
| 2058 | \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
|
|---|
| 2059 |
|
|---|
| 2060 | \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
|
|---|
| 2061 | \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
|
|---|
| 2062 |
|
|---|
| 2063 | \envdef\titlepage{%
|
|---|
| 2064 | % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
|
|---|
| 2065 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 2066 | \parindent=0pt \textfonts
|
|---|
| 2067 | % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
|
|---|
| 2068 | \vglue\titlepagetopglue
|
|---|
| 2069 | % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
|
|---|
| 2070 | \finishedtitlepagetrue
|
|---|
| 2071 | %
|
|---|
| 2072 | % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
|
|---|
| 2073 | % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
|
|---|
| 2074 | \let\oldpage = \page
|
|---|
| 2075 | \def\page{%
|
|---|
| 2076 | \iffinishedtitlepage\else
|
|---|
| 2077 | \finishtitlepage
|
|---|
| 2078 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2079 | \let\page = \oldpage
|
|---|
| 2080 | \page
|
|---|
| 2081 | \null
|
|---|
| 2082 | }%
|
|---|
| 2083 | }
|
|---|
| 2084 |
|
|---|
| 2085 | \def\Etitlepage{%
|
|---|
| 2086 | \iffinishedtitlepage\else
|
|---|
| 2087 | \finishtitlepage
|
|---|
| 2088 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2089 | % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
|
|---|
| 2090 | % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
|
|---|
| 2091 | % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
|
|---|
| 2092 | % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
|
|---|
| 2093 | \oldpage
|
|---|
| 2094 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 2095 | %
|
|---|
| 2096 | % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
|
|---|
| 2097 | % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
|
|---|
| 2098 | \HEADINGSon
|
|---|
| 2099 | %
|
|---|
| 2100 | % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
|
|---|
| 2101 | \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
|
|---|
| 2102 | \shortcontents
|
|---|
| 2103 | \contents
|
|---|
| 2104 | \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
|
|---|
| 2105 | \global\let\contents = \relax
|
|---|
| 2106 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2107 | %
|
|---|
| 2108 | \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
|
|---|
| 2109 | \contents
|
|---|
| 2110 | \global\let\contents = \relax
|
|---|
| 2111 | \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
|
|---|
| 2112 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2113 | }
|
|---|
| 2114 |
|
|---|
| 2115 | \def\finishtitlepage{%
|
|---|
| 2116 | \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
|
|---|
| 2117 | \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
|
|---|
| 2118 | \finishedtitlepagetrue
|
|---|
| 2119 | }
|
|---|
| 2120 |
|
|---|
| 2121 | %%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
|
|---|
| 2122 |
|
|---|
| 2123 | \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
|
|---|
| 2124 | \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
|
|---|
| 2125 |
|
|---|
| 2126 | \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines
|
|---|
| 2127 | \let\tt=\authortt}
|
|---|
| 2128 |
|
|---|
| 2129 | \parseargdef\title{%
|
|---|
| 2130 | \checkenv\titlepage
|
|---|
| 2131 | \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1}
|
|---|
| 2132 | % print a rule at the page bottom also.
|
|---|
| 2133 | \finishedtitlepagefalse
|
|---|
| 2134 | \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
|
|---|
| 2135 | }
|
|---|
| 2136 |
|
|---|
| 2137 | \parseargdef\subtitle{%
|
|---|
| 2138 | \checkenv\titlepage
|
|---|
| 2139 | {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
|
|---|
| 2140 | }
|
|---|
| 2141 |
|
|---|
| 2142 | % @author should come last, but may come many times.
|
|---|
| 2143 | % It can also be used inside @quotation.
|
|---|
| 2144 | %
|
|---|
| 2145 | \parseargdef\author{%
|
|---|
| 2146 | \def\temp{\quotation}%
|
|---|
| 2147 | \ifx\thisenv\temp
|
|---|
| 2148 | \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
|
|---|
| 2149 | \else
|
|---|
| 2150 | \checkenv\titlepage
|
|---|
| 2151 | \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
|
|---|
| 2152 | {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}%
|
|---|
| 2153 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2154 | }
|
|---|
| 2155 |
|
|---|
| 2156 |
|
|---|
| 2157 | %%% Set up page headings and footings.
|
|---|
| 2158 |
|
|---|
| 2159 | \let\thispage=\folio
|
|---|
| 2160 |
|
|---|
| 2161 | \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
|
|---|
| 2162 | \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
|
|---|
| 2163 | \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
|
|---|
| 2164 | \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
|
|---|
| 2165 |
|
|---|
| 2166 | % Now make TeX use those variables
|
|---|
| 2167 | \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
|
|---|
| 2168 | \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
|
|---|
| 2169 | \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
|
|---|
| 2170 | \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
|
|---|
| 2171 | \let\HEADINGShook=\relax
|
|---|
| 2172 |
|
|---|
| 2173 | % Commands to set those variables.
|
|---|
| 2174 | % For example, this is what @headings on does
|
|---|
| 2175 | % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
|
|---|
| 2176 | % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
|
|---|
| 2177 | % @evenfooting @thisfile||
|
|---|
| 2178 | % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
|
|---|
| 2179 |
|
|---|
| 2180 |
|
|---|
| 2181 | \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
|
|---|
| 2182 | \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
|
|---|
| 2183 | \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
|
|---|
| 2184 | \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
|
|---|
| 2185 |
|
|---|
| 2186 | \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
|
|---|
| 2187 | \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
|
|---|
| 2188 | \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
|
|---|
| 2189 | \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
|
|---|
| 2190 |
|
|---|
| 2191 | \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
|
|---|
| 2192 |
|
|---|
| 2193 | \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
|
|---|
| 2194 | \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
|
|---|
| 2195 | \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
|
|---|
| 2196 | \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
|
|---|
| 2197 |
|
|---|
| 2198 | \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
|
|---|
| 2199 | \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
|
|---|
| 2200 | \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
|
|---|
| 2201 | \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
|
|---|
| 2202 | %
|
|---|
| 2203 | % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
|
|---|
| 2204 | % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
|
|---|
| 2205 | \global\advance\pageheight by -\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 2206 | \global\advance\vsize by -\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 2207 | }
|
|---|
| 2208 |
|
|---|
| 2209 | \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
|
|---|
| 2210 |
|
|---|
| 2211 |
|
|---|
| 2212 | % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
|
|---|
| 2213 | % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
|
|---|
| 2214 | % @headings off turns them off.
|
|---|
| 2215 | % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
|
|---|
| 2216 | % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
|
|---|
| 2217 | % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
|
|---|
| 2218 | % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
|
|---|
| 2219 | % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
|
|---|
| 2220 | % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
|
|---|
| 2221 |
|
|---|
| 2222 | \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
|
|---|
| 2223 |
|
|---|
| 2224 | \def\HEADINGSoff{%
|
|---|
| 2225 | \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
|
|---|
| 2226 | \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}}
|
|---|
| 2227 | \HEADINGSoff
|
|---|
| 2228 | % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
|
|---|
| 2229 | % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
|
|---|
| 2230 | % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
|
|---|
| 2231 | % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
|
|---|
| 2232 | % edge of all pages.
|
|---|
| 2233 | \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
|
|---|
| 2234 | \global\pageno=1
|
|---|
| 2235 | \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
|
|---|
| 2236 | \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
|
|---|
| 2237 | \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
|
|---|
| 2238 | \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
|
|---|
| 2239 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
|
|---|
| 2240 | }
|
|---|
| 2241 | \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
|
|---|
| 2242 |
|
|---|
| 2243 | % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
|
|---|
| 2244 | % page number on top right.
|
|---|
| 2245 | \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
|
|---|
| 2246 | \global\pageno=1
|
|---|
| 2247 | \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
|
|---|
| 2248 | \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
|
|---|
| 2249 | \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
|
|---|
| 2250 | \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
|
|---|
| 2251 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
|
|---|
| 2252 | }
|
|---|
| 2253 | \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
|
|---|
| 2254 |
|
|---|
| 2255 | \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
|
|---|
| 2256 | \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
|
|---|
| 2257 | \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
|
|---|
| 2258 | \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
|
|---|
| 2259 | \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
|
|---|
| 2260 | \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
|
|---|
| 2261 | \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
|
|---|
| 2262 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
|
|---|
| 2263 | }
|
|---|
| 2264 |
|
|---|
| 2265 | \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
|
|---|
| 2266 | \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
|
|---|
| 2267 | \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
|
|---|
| 2268 | \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
|
|---|
| 2269 | \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
|
|---|
| 2270 | \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
|
|---|
| 2271 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
|
|---|
| 2272 | }
|
|---|
| 2273 |
|
|---|
| 2274 | % Subroutines used in generating headings
|
|---|
| 2275 | % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
|
|---|
| 2276 | % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
|
|---|
| 2277 | % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
|
|---|
| 2278 | \ifx\today\undefined
|
|---|
| 2279 | \def\today{%
|
|---|
| 2280 | \number\day\space
|
|---|
| 2281 | \ifcase\month
|
|---|
| 2282 | \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
|
|---|
| 2283 | \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
|
|---|
| 2284 | \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
|
|---|
| 2285 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2286 | \space\number\year}
|
|---|
| 2287 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2288 |
|
|---|
| 2289 | % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
|
|---|
| 2290 | % It generates no output of its own.
|
|---|
| 2291 | \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
|
|---|
| 2292 | \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
|
|---|
| 2293 |
|
|---|
| 2294 |
|
|---|
| 2295 | \message{tables,}
|
|---|
| 2296 | % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
|
|---|
| 2297 |
|
|---|
| 2298 | % default indentation of table text
|
|---|
| 2299 | \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
|
|---|
| 2300 | % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
|
|---|
| 2301 | \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
|
|---|
| 2302 | % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
|
|---|
| 2303 | \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
|
|---|
| 2304 |
|
|---|
| 2305 | % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
|
|---|
| 2306 | \newdimen\itemmax
|
|---|
| 2307 |
|
|---|
| 2308 | % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
|
|---|
| 2309 | % these defs.
|
|---|
| 2310 | % They also define \itemindex
|
|---|
| 2311 | % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
|
|---|
| 2312 |
|
|---|
| 2313 | \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
|
|---|
| 2314 |
|
|---|
| 2315 | \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
|
|---|
| 2316 |
|
|---|
| 2317 | \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
|
|---|
| 2318 | \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
|
|---|
| 2319 |
|
|---|
| 2320 | \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
|
|---|
| 2321 | \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
|
|---|
| 2322 | \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
|
|---|
| 2323 | \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
|
|---|
| 2324 | \itemindex{#1}%
|
|---|
| 2325 | \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
|
|---|
| 2326 | %
|
|---|
| 2327 | % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
|
|---|
| 2328 | % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
|
|---|
| 2329 | % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
|
|---|
| 2330 | % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
|
|---|
| 2331 | % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
|
|---|
| 2332 | \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
|
|---|
| 2333 | %
|
|---|
| 2334 | % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
|
|---|
| 2335 | % but leave it ragged-right.
|
|---|
| 2336 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 2337 | \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
|
|---|
| 2338 | \advance\hsize by\tableindent
|
|---|
| 2339 | \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
|
|---|
| 2340 | \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
|
|---|
| 2341 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 2342 | %
|
|---|
| 2343 | % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
|
|---|
| 2344 | % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
|
|---|
| 2345 | \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
|
|---|
| 2346 | %
|
|---|
| 2347 | % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
|
|---|
| 2348 | % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
|
|---|
| 2349 | % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
|
|---|
| 2350 | % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
|
|---|
| 2351 | % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
|
|---|
| 2352 | % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
|
|---|
| 2353 | %
|
|---|
| 2354 | \penalty 10001
|
|---|
| 2355 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 2356 | \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
|
|---|
| 2357 | \else
|
|---|
| 2358 | % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
|
|---|
| 2359 | % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
|
|---|
| 2360 | \noindent
|
|---|
| 2361 | % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
|
|---|
| 2362 | % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
|
|---|
| 2363 | % eventually be printed.
|
|---|
| 2364 | \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
|
|---|
| 2365 | \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
|
|---|
| 2366 | \unhbox0
|
|---|
| 2367 | \nobreak\kern\dimen0
|
|---|
| 2368 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 2369 | \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
|
|---|
| 2370 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2371 | }
|
|---|
| 2372 |
|
|---|
| 2373 | \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
|
|---|
| 2374 | \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
|
|---|
| 2375 |
|
|---|
| 2376 | % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
|
|---|
| 2377 | \envdef\table{%
|
|---|
| 2378 | \let\itemindex\gobble
|
|---|
| 2379 | \tablecheck{table}%
|
|---|
| 2380 | }
|
|---|
| 2381 | \envdef\ftable{%
|
|---|
| 2382 | \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
|
|---|
| 2383 | \tablecheck{ftable}%
|
|---|
| 2384 | }
|
|---|
| 2385 | \envdef\vtable{%
|
|---|
| 2386 | \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
|
|---|
| 2387 | \tablecheck{vtable}%
|
|---|
| 2388 | }
|
|---|
| 2389 | \def\tablecheck#1{%
|
|---|
| 2390 | \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
|
|---|
| 2391 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 2392 | \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
|
|---|
| 2393 | that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
|
|---|
| 2394 | \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
|
|---|
| 2395 | \else
|
|---|
| 2396 | \let\next\tablex
|
|---|
| 2397 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2398 | \next
|
|---|
| 2399 | }
|
|---|
| 2400 | \def\tablex#1{%
|
|---|
| 2401 | \def\itemindicate{#1}%
|
|---|
| 2402 | \parsearg\tabley
|
|---|
| 2403 | }
|
|---|
| 2404 | \def\tabley#1{%
|
|---|
| 2405 | {%
|
|---|
| 2406 | \makevalueexpandable
|
|---|
| 2407 | \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
|
|---|
| 2408 | \expandafter
|
|---|
| 2409 | }\temp \endtablez
|
|---|
| 2410 | }
|
|---|
| 2411 | \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
|
|---|
| 2412 | \aboveenvbreak
|
|---|
| 2413 | \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
|
|---|
| 2414 | \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
|
|---|
| 2415 | \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
|
|---|
| 2416 | \itemmax=\tableindent
|
|---|
| 2417 | \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
|
|---|
| 2418 | \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
|
|---|
| 2419 | \exdentamount=\tableindent
|
|---|
| 2420 | \parindent = 0pt
|
|---|
| 2421 | \parskip = \smallskipamount
|
|---|
| 2422 | \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
|
|---|
| 2423 | \let\item = \internalBitem
|
|---|
| 2424 | \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
|
|---|
| 2425 | }
|
|---|
| 2426 | \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
|
|---|
| 2427 | \let\Eftable\Etable
|
|---|
| 2428 | \let\Evtable\Etable
|
|---|
| 2429 | \let\Eitemize\Etable
|
|---|
| 2430 | \let\Eenumerate\Etable
|
|---|
| 2431 |
|
|---|
| 2432 | % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
|
|---|
| 2433 |
|
|---|
| 2434 | \newcount \itemno
|
|---|
| 2435 |
|
|---|
| 2436 | \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
|
|---|
| 2437 |
|
|---|
| 2438 | \def\doitemize#1{%
|
|---|
| 2439 | \aboveenvbreak
|
|---|
| 2440 | \itemmax=\itemindent
|
|---|
| 2441 | \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
|
|---|
| 2442 | \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
|
|---|
| 2443 | \exdentamount=\itemindent
|
|---|
| 2444 | \parindent=0pt
|
|---|
| 2445 | \parskip=\smallskipamount
|
|---|
| 2446 | \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
|
|---|
| 2447 | \def\itemcontents{#1}%
|
|---|
| 2448 | % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
|
|---|
| 2449 | \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
|
|---|
| 2450 | \let\item=\itemizeitem
|
|---|
| 2451 | }
|
|---|
| 2452 |
|
|---|
| 2453 | % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
|
|---|
| 2454 | %
|
|---|
| 2455 | \def\itemizeitem{%
|
|---|
| 2456 | \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
|
|---|
| 2457 | {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
|
|---|
| 2458 | {%
|
|---|
| 2459 | % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
|
|---|
| 2460 | % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
|
|---|
| 2461 | % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
|
|---|
| 2462 | % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
|
|---|
| 2463 | % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
|
|---|
| 2464 | % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
|
|---|
| 2465 | % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
|
|---|
| 2466 | % that's the theory.
|
|---|
| 2467 | \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
|
|---|
| 2468 | \noindent
|
|---|
| 2469 | \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
|
|---|
| 2470 | \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
|
|---|
| 2471 | \flushcr
|
|---|
| 2472 | }
|
|---|
| 2473 |
|
|---|
| 2474 | % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
|
|---|
| 2475 | % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
|
|---|
| 2476 | %
|
|---|
| 2477 | \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
|
|---|
| 2478 |
|
|---|
| 2479 | % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
|
|---|
| 2480 | % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
|
|---|
| 2481 | % argument is the same as `1'.
|
|---|
| 2482 | %
|
|---|
| 2483 | \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
|
|---|
| 2484 | \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
|
|---|
| 2485 | % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
|
|---|
| 2486 | \def\thearg{#1}%
|
|---|
| 2487 | \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
|
|---|
| 2488 | %
|
|---|
| 2489 | % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
|
|---|
| 2490 | % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
|
|---|
| 2491 | % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
|
|---|
| 2492 | % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
|
|---|
| 2493 | % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
|
|---|
| 2494 | \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
|
|---|
| 2495 | \ifx\rest\empty
|
|---|
| 2496 | % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
|
|---|
| 2497 | % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
|
|---|
| 2498 | % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
|
|---|
| 2499 | % not equal to itself.
|
|---|
| 2500 | % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
|
|---|
| 2501 | %
|
|---|
| 2502 | % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
|
|---|
| 2503 | % continuing to look for a <number>.
|
|---|
| 2504 | %
|
|---|
| 2505 | \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
|
|---|
| 2506 | \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
|
|---|
| 2507 | \else
|
|---|
| 2508 | % It's a letter.
|
|---|
| 2509 | \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
|
|---|
| 2510 | \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
|
|---|
| 2511 | \else
|
|---|
| 2512 | \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
|
|---|
| 2513 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2514 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2515 | \else
|
|---|
| 2516 | % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
|
|---|
| 2517 | \numericenumerate
|
|---|
| 2518 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2519 | }
|
|---|
| 2520 |
|
|---|
| 2521 | % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
|
|---|
| 2522 | % given in \thearg.
|
|---|
| 2523 | %
|
|---|
| 2524 | \def\numericenumerate{%
|
|---|
| 2525 | \itemno = \thearg
|
|---|
| 2526 | \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
|
|---|
| 2527 | }
|
|---|
| 2528 |
|
|---|
| 2529 | % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
|
|---|
| 2530 | \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
|
|---|
| 2531 | \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
|
|---|
| 2532 | \startenumeration{%
|
|---|
| 2533 | % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
|
|---|
| 2534 | \ifnum\itemno=0
|
|---|
| 2535 | \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
|
|---|
| 2536 | alphabet}%
|
|---|
| 2537 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2538 | \char\lccode\itemno
|
|---|
| 2539 | }%
|
|---|
| 2540 | }
|
|---|
| 2541 |
|
|---|
| 2542 | % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
|
|---|
| 2543 | \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
|
|---|
| 2544 | \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
|
|---|
| 2545 | \startenumeration{%
|
|---|
| 2546 | % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
|
|---|
| 2547 | \ifnum\itemno=0
|
|---|
| 2548 | \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
|
|---|
| 2549 | alphabet}
|
|---|
| 2550 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2551 | \char\uccode\itemno
|
|---|
| 2552 | }%
|
|---|
| 2553 | }
|
|---|
| 2554 |
|
|---|
| 2555 | % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
|
|---|
| 2556 | % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
|
|---|
| 2557 | % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
|
|---|
| 2558 | %
|
|---|
| 2559 | \def\startenumeration#1{%
|
|---|
| 2560 | \advance\itemno by -1
|
|---|
| 2561 | \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
|
|---|
| 2562 | }
|
|---|
| 2563 |
|
|---|
| 2564 | % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
|
|---|
| 2565 | % to @enumerate.
|
|---|
| 2566 | %
|
|---|
| 2567 | \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
|
|---|
| 2568 | \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
|
|---|
| 2569 | \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
|
|---|
| 2570 | \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
|
|---|
| 2571 |
|
|---|
| 2572 |
|
|---|
| 2573 | % @multitable macros
|
|---|
| 2574 | % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
|
|---|
| 2575 | %
|
|---|
| 2576 | % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
|
|---|
| 2577 | % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
|
|---|
| 2578 | % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
|
|---|
| 2579 | % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
|
|---|
| 2580 |
|
|---|
| 2581 | % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
|
|---|
| 2582 |
|
|---|
| 2583 | % To make preamble:
|
|---|
| 2584 | %
|
|---|
| 2585 | % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
|
|---|
| 2586 | % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
|
|---|
| 2587 | % @item ...
|
|---|
| 2588 | %
|
|---|
| 2589 | % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
|
|---|
| 2590 | % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
|
|---|
| 2591 | % columns as desired.
|
|---|
| 2592 |
|
|---|
| 2593 |
|
|---|
| 2594 | % Or use a template:
|
|---|
| 2595 | % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
|
|---|
| 2596 | % @item ...
|
|---|
| 2597 | % using the widest term desired in each column.
|
|---|
| 2598 |
|
|---|
| 2599 | % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
|
|---|
| 2600 | % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
|
|---|
| 2601 | % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
|
|---|
| 2602 | % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
|
|---|
| 2603 |
|
|---|
| 2604 | % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
|
|---|
| 2605 | % if they are.
|
|---|
| 2606 |
|
|---|
| 2607 | % Sample multitable:
|
|---|
| 2608 |
|
|---|
| 2609 | % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
|
|---|
| 2610 | % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
|
|---|
| 2611 | % @item
|
|---|
| 2612 | % first col stuff
|
|---|
| 2613 | % @tab
|
|---|
| 2614 | % second col stuff
|
|---|
| 2615 | % @tab
|
|---|
| 2616 | % third col
|
|---|
| 2617 | % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
|
|---|
| 2618 | % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
|
|---|
| 2619 | %
|
|---|
| 2620 | % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
|
|---|
| 2621 | % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
|
|---|
| 2622 | % @end multitable
|
|---|
| 2623 |
|
|---|
| 2624 | % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
|
|---|
| 2625 | % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
|
|---|
| 2626 | % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
|
|---|
| 2627 | % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
|
|---|
| 2628 | % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
|
|---|
| 2629 | % to baseline.
|
|---|
| 2630 | % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
|
|---|
| 2631 | %
|
|---|
| 2632 | \newskip\multitableparskip
|
|---|
| 2633 | \newskip\multitableparindent
|
|---|
| 2634 | \newdimen\multitablecolspace
|
|---|
| 2635 | \newskip\multitablelinespace
|
|---|
| 2636 | \multitableparskip=0pt
|
|---|
| 2637 | \multitableparindent=6pt
|
|---|
| 2638 | \multitablecolspace=12pt
|
|---|
| 2639 | \multitablelinespace=0pt
|
|---|
| 2640 |
|
|---|
| 2641 | % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
|
|---|
| 2642 | %
|
|---|
| 2643 | \let\endsetuptable\relax
|
|---|
| 2644 | \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
|
|---|
| 2645 | \let\columnfractions\relax
|
|---|
| 2646 | \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
|
|---|
| 2647 | \newif\ifsetpercent
|
|---|
| 2648 |
|
|---|
| 2649 | % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
|
|---|
| 2650 | % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
|
|---|
| 2651 | %
|
|---|
| 2652 | \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
|
|---|
| 2653 | \global\advance\colcount by 1
|
|---|
| 2654 | \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
|
|---|
| 2655 | \setuptable
|
|---|
| 2656 | }
|
|---|
| 2657 |
|
|---|
| 2658 | \newcount\colcount
|
|---|
| 2659 | \def\setuptable#1{%
|
|---|
| 2660 | \def\firstarg{#1}%
|
|---|
| 2661 | \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
|
|---|
| 2662 | \let\go = \relax
|
|---|
| 2663 | \else
|
|---|
| 2664 | \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
|
|---|
| 2665 | \global\setpercenttrue
|
|---|
| 2666 | \else
|
|---|
| 2667 | \ifsetpercent
|
|---|
| 2668 | \let\go\pickupwholefraction
|
|---|
| 2669 | \else
|
|---|
| 2670 | \global\advance\colcount by 1
|
|---|
| 2671 | \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
|
|---|
| 2672 | % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
|
|---|
| 2673 | \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
|
|---|
| 2674 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2675 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2676 | \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
|
|---|
| 2677 | % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
|
|---|
| 2678 | % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
|
|---|
| 2679 | \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
|
|---|
| 2680 | \else
|
|---|
| 2681 | \let\go = \setuptable
|
|---|
| 2682 | \fi%
|
|---|
| 2683 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2684 | \go
|
|---|
| 2685 | }
|
|---|
| 2686 |
|
|---|
| 2687 | % multitable-only commands.
|
|---|
| 2688 | %
|
|---|
| 2689 | % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
|
|---|
| 2690 | % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
|
|---|
| 2691 | % of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab.
|
|---|
| 2692 | \def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}%
|
|---|
| 2693 | %
|
|---|
| 2694 | % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
|
|---|
| 2695 | % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
|
|---|
| 2696 | % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
|
|---|
| 2697 | % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
|
|---|
| 2698 | \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
|
|---|
| 2699 |
|
|---|
| 2700 | % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
|
|---|
| 2701 | %
|
|---|
| 2702 | \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
|
|---|
| 2703 | %
|
|---|
| 2704 | \envdef\multitable{%
|
|---|
| 2705 | \vskip\parskip
|
|---|
| 2706 | \startsavinginserts
|
|---|
| 2707 | %
|
|---|
| 2708 | % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
|
|---|
| 2709 | % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
|
|---|
| 2710 | % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
|
|---|
| 2711 | % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
|
|---|
| 2712 | \def\item{\crcr}%
|
|---|
| 2713 | %
|
|---|
| 2714 | \tolerance=9500
|
|---|
| 2715 | \hbadness=9500
|
|---|
| 2716 | \setmultitablespacing
|
|---|
| 2717 | \parskip=\multitableparskip
|
|---|
| 2718 | \parindent=\multitableparindent
|
|---|
| 2719 | \overfullrule=0pt
|
|---|
| 2720 | \global\colcount=0
|
|---|
| 2721 | %
|
|---|
| 2722 | \everycr = {%
|
|---|
| 2723 | \noalign{%
|
|---|
| 2724 | \global\everytab={}%
|
|---|
| 2725 | \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
|
|---|
| 2726 | % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
|
|---|
| 2727 | \checkinserts
|
|---|
| 2728 | % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
|
|---|
| 2729 | %\filbreak
|
|---|
| 2730 | % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
|
|---|
| 2731 | % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
|
|---|
| 2732 | % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
|
|---|
| 2733 | }%
|
|---|
| 2734 | }%
|
|---|
| 2735 | %
|
|---|
| 2736 | \parsearg\domultitable
|
|---|
| 2737 | }
|
|---|
| 2738 | \def\domultitable#1{%
|
|---|
| 2739 | % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
|
|---|
| 2740 | \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
|
|---|
| 2741 | %
|
|---|
| 2742 | % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
|
|---|
| 2743 | % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
|
|---|
| 2744 | % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
|
|---|
| 2745 | % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
|
|---|
| 2746 | \halign\bgroup &%
|
|---|
| 2747 | \global\advance\colcount by 1
|
|---|
| 2748 | \multistrut
|
|---|
| 2749 | \vtop{%
|
|---|
| 2750 | % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
|
|---|
| 2751 | \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
|
|---|
| 2752 | %
|
|---|
| 2753 | % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
|
|---|
| 2754 | % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
|
|---|
| 2755 | % the first one.
|
|---|
| 2756 | %
|
|---|
| 2757 | % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
|
|---|
| 2758 | % to the width of each template entry.
|
|---|
| 2759 | %
|
|---|
| 2760 | % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
|
|---|
| 2761 | % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
|
|---|
| 2762 | % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
|
|---|
| 2763 | % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
|
|---|
| 2764 | %
|
|---|
| 2765 | % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
|
|---|
| 2766 | \rightskip=0pt
|
|---|
| 2767 | \ifnum\colcount=1
|
|---|
| 2768 | % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
|
|---|
| 2769 | \advance\hsize by\leftskip
|
|---|
| 2770 | \else
|
|---|
| 2771 | \ifsetpercent \else
|
|---|
| 2772 | % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
|
|---|
| 2773 | % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
|
|---|
| 2774 | \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
|
|---|
| 2775 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2776 | % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
|
|---|
| 2777 | \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
|
|---|
| 2778 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2779 | % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
|
|---|
| 2780 | % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
|
|---|
| 2781 | % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
|
|---|
| 2782 | % For example:
|
|---|
| 2783 | % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
|
|---|
| 2784 | % @item @code{#}
|
|---|
| 2785 | % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
|
|---|
| 2786 | % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
|
|---|
| 2787 | % marking characters.
|
|---|
| 2788 | \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
|
|---|
| 2789 | }\cr
|
|---|
| 2790 | }
|
|---|
| 2791 | \def\Emultitable{%
|
|---|
| 2792 | \crcr
|
|---|
| 2793 | \egroup % end the \halign
|
|---|
| 2794 | \global\setpercentfalse
|
|---|
| 2795 | }
|
|---|
| 2796 |
|
|---|
| 2797 | \def\setmultitablespacing{%
|
|---|
| 2798 | \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
|
|---|
| 2799 | %
|
|---|
| 2800 | % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
|
|---|
| 2801 | % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
|
|---|
| 2802 | % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
|
|---|
| 2803 | % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
|
|---|
| 2804 | \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
|
|---|
| 2805 | \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 2806 | \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
|
|---|
| 2807 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2808 | %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
|
|---|
| 2809 | %% table. If not, do nothing.
|
|---|
| 2810 | %% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
|
|---|
| 2811 | \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
|
|---|
| 2812 | \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
|
|---|
| 2813 | \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
|
|---|
| 2814 | %% than skip between lines in the table.
|
|---|
| 2815 | \fi%
|
|---|
| 2816 | \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
|
|---|
| 2817 | \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
|
|---|
| 2818 | \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
|
|---|
| 2819 | %% than skip between lines in the table.
|
|---|
| 2820 | \fi}
|
|---|
| 2821 |
|
|---|
| 2822 |
|
|---|
| 2823 | \message{conditionals,}
|
|---|
| 2824 |
|
|---|
| 2825 | % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
|
|---|
| 2826 | % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
|
|---|
| 2827 | % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
|
|---|
| 2828 | % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
|
|---|
| 2829 | % attempt to close an environment group.
|
|---|
| 2830 | %
|
|---|
| 2831 | \def\makecond#1{%
|
|---|
| 2832 | \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
|
|---|
| 2833 | \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
|
|---|
| 2834 | }
|
|---|
| 2835 | \makecond{iftex}
|
|---|
| 2836 | \makecond{ifnotdocbook}
|
|---|
| 2837 | \makecond{ifnothtml}
|
|---|
| 2838 | \makecond{ifnotinfo}
|
|---|
| 2839 | \makecond{ifnotplaintext}
|
|---|
| 2840 | \makecond{ifnotxml}
|
|---|
| 2841 |
|
|---|
| 2842 | % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
|
|---|
| 2843 | %
|
|---|
| 2844 | \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
|
|---|
| 2845 | \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
|
|---|
| 2846 | \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
|
|---|
| 2847 | \def\html{\doignore{html}}
|
|---|
| 2848 | \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
|
|---|
| 2849 | \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
|
|---|
| 2850 | \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
|
|---|
| 2851 | \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
|
|---|
| 2852 | \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
|
|---|
| 2853 | \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
|
|---|
| 2854 | \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
|
|---|
| 2855 | \def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
|
|---|
| 2856 | \def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
|
|---|
| 2857 |
|
|---|
| 2858 | % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
|
|---|
| 2859 | %
|
|---|
| 2860 | % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
|
|---|
| 2861 | \newcount\doignorecount
|
|---|
| 2862 |
|
|---|
| 2863 | \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 2864 | % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
|
|---|
| 2865 | \catcode`\@ = \other
|
|---|
| 2866 | \catcode`\{ = \other
|
|---|
| 2867 | \catcode`\} = \other
|
|---|
| 2868 | %
|
|---|
| 2869 | % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
|
|---|
| 2870 | \spaceisspace
|
|---|
| 2871 | %
|
|---|
| 2872 | % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
|
|---|
| 2873 | \doignorecount = 0
|
|---|
| 2874 | %
|
|---|
| 2875 | % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
|
|---|
| 2876 | \dodoignore{#1}%
|
|---|
| 2877 | }
|
|---|
| 2878 |
|
|---|
| 2879 | { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
|
|---|
| 2880 | \obeylines %
|
|---|
| 2881 | %
|
|---|
| 2882 | \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
|
|---|
| 2883 | % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
|
|---|
| 2884 | %
|
|---|
| 2885 | % Define a command to find the next `@end #1', which must be on a line
|
|---|
| 2886 | % by itself.
|
|---|
| 2887 | \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
|
|---|
| 2888 | % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
|
|---|
| 2889 | % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
|
|---|
| 2890 | % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
|
|---|
| 2891 | \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
|
|---|
| 2892 | %
|
|---|
| 2893 | % And now expand that command.
|
|---|
| 2894 | \obeylines %
|
|---|
| 2895 | \doignoretext ^^M%
|
|---|
| 2896 | }%
|
|---|
| 2897 | }
|
|---|
| 2898 |
|
|---|
| 2899 | \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
|
|---|
| 2900 | \def\temp{#1}%
|
|---|
| 2901 | \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
|
|---|
| 2902 | \let\next\doignoretextzzz
|
|---|
| 2903 | \else % Found a nested condition, ...
|
|---|
| 2904 | \advance\doignorecount by 1
|
|---|
| 2905 | \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
|
|---|
| 2906 | % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
|
|---|
| 2907 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2908 | \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
|
|---|
| 2909 | }
|
|---|
| 2910 |
|
|---|
| 2911 | % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
|
|---|
| 2912 | %
|
|---|
| 2913 | \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 2914 | \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
|
|---|
| 2915 | \let\next\enddoignore
|
|---|
| 2916 | \else % Still inside a nested condition.
|
|---|
| 2917 | \advance\doignorecount by -1
|
|---|
| 2918 | \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
|
|---|
| 2919 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2920 | \next
|
|---|
| 2921 | }
|
|---|
| 2922 |
|
|---|
| 2923 | % Finish off ignored text.
|
|---|
| 2924 | \def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces}
|
|---|
| 2925 |
|
|---|
| 2926 |
|
|---|
| 2927 | % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
|
|---|
| 2928 | % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
|
|---|
| 2929 | %
|
|---|
| 2930 | % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
|
|---|
| 2931 | % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
|
|---|
| 2932 | % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
|
|---|
| 2933 | % didn't need it.
|
|---|
| 2934 | % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
|
|---|
| 2935 | %
|
|---|
| 2936 | \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
|
|---|
| 2937 | \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
|
|---|
| 2938 | {%
|
|---|
| 2939 | \makevalueexpandable
|
|---|
| 2940 | \def\temp{#2}%
|
|---|
| 2941 | \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
|
|---|
| 2942 | \ifx\temp\empty
|
|---|
| 2943 | \next{}%
|
|---|
| 2944 | \else
|
|---|
| 2945 | \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
|
|---|
| 2946 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2947 | }%
|
|---|
| 2948 | }
|
|---|
| 2949 | % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
|
|---|
| 2950 | \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
|
|---|
| 2951 |
|
|---|
| 2952 | % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
|
|---|
| 2953 | %
|
|---|
| 2954 | \parseargdef\clear{%
|
|---|
| 2955 | {%
|
|---|
| 2956 | \makevalueexpandable
|
|---|
| 2957 | \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
|
|---|
| 2958 | }%
|
|---|
| 2959 | }
|
|---|
| 2960 |
|
|---|
| 2961 | % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
|
|---|
| 2962 | \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
|
|---|
| 2963 | \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
|
|---|
| 2964 | {
|
|---|
| 2965 | \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active
|
|---|
| 2966 | %
|
|---|
| 2967 | \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
|
|---|
| 2968 | \let\value = \expandablevalue
|
|---|
| 2969 | % We don't want these characters active, ...
|
|---|
| 2970 | \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
|
|---|
| 2971 | % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
|
|---|
| 2972 | % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
|
|---|
| 2973 | % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
|
|---|
| 2974 | \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
|
|---|
| 2975 | }
|
|---|
| 2976 | }
|
|---|
| 2977 |
|
|---|
| 2978 | % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
|
|---|
| 2979 | % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
|
|---|
| 2980 | % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
|
|---|
| 2981 | % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
|
|---|
| 2982 | % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
|
|---|
| 2983 | % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
|
|---|
| 2984 | % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
|
|---|
| 2985 | %
|
|---|
| 2986 | \def\expandablevalue#1{%
|
|---|
| 2987 | \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
|
|---|
| 2988 | {[No value for ``#1'']}%
|
|---|
| 2989 | \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
|
|---|
| 2990 | \else
|
|---|
| 2991 | \csname SET#1\endcsname
|
|---|
| 2992 | \fi
|
|---|
| 2993 | }
|
|---|
| 2994 |
|
|---|
| 2995 | % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
|
|---|
| 2996 | % with @set.
|
|---|
| 2997 | %
|
|---|
| 2998 | % To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
|
|---|
| 2999 | %
|
|---|
| 3000 | \makecond{ifset}
|
|---|
| 3001 | \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
|
|---|
| 3002 | \def\doifset#1#2{%
|
|---|
| 3003 | {%
|
|---|
| 3004 | \makevalueexpandable
|
|---|
| 3005 | \let\next=\empty
|
|---|
| 3006 | \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
|
|---|
| 3007 | #1% If not set, redefine \next.
|
|---|
| 3008 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3009 | \expandafter
|
|---|
| 3010 | }\next
|
|---|
| 3011 | }
|
|---|
| 3012 | \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
|
|---|
| 3013 |
|
|---|
| 3014 | % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
|
|---|
| 3015 | % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
|
|---|
| 3016 | %
|
|---|
| 3017 | % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
|
|---|
| 3018 | % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
|
|---|
| 3019 | % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
|
|---|
| 3020 | %
|
|---|
| 3021 | \makecond{ifclear}
|
|---|
| 3022 | \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
|
|---|
| 3023 | \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
|
|---|
| 3024 |
|
|---|
| 3025 | % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
|
|---|
| 3026 | % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
|
|---|
| 3027 | \let\dircategory=\comment
|
|---|
| 3028 |
|
|---|
| 3029 | % @defininfoenclose.
|
|---|
| 3030 | \let\definfoenclose=\comment
|
|---|
| 3031 |
|
|---|
| 3032 |
|
|---|
| 3033 | \message{indexing,}
|
|---|
| 3034 | % Index generation facilities
|
|---|
| 3035 |
|
|---|
| 3036 | % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
|
|---|
| 3037 | % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
|
|---|
| 3038 | \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
|
|---|
| 3039 |
|
|---|
| 3040 | % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
|
|---|
| 3041 | % It automatically defines \fooindex such that
|
|---|
| 3042 | % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
|
|---|
| 3043 | % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
|
|---|
| 3044 | % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
|
|---|
| 3045 | % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
|
|---|
| 3046 | % for the sake of vms.
|
|---|
| 3047 | %
|
|---|
| 3048 | \def\newindex#1{%
|
|---|
| 3049 | \iflinks
|
|---|
| 3050 | \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
|
|---|
| 3051 | \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
|
|---|
| 3052 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3053 | \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
|
|---|
| 3054 | \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
|
|---|
| 3055 | }
|
|---|
| 3056 |
|
|---|
| 3057 | % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
|
|---|
| 3058 | %
|
|---|
| 3059 | \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
|
|---|
| 3060 |
|
|---|
| 3061 | % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
|
|---|
| 3062 | %
|
|---|
| 3063 | \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
|
|---|
| 3064 | %
|
|---|
| 3065 | \def\newcodeindex#1{%
|
|---|
| 3066 | \iflinks
|
|---|
| 3067 | \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
|
|---|
| 3068 | \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1
|
|---|
| 3069 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3070 | \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
|
|---|
| 3071 | \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
|
|---|
| 3072 | }
|
|---|
| 3073 |
|
|---|
| 3074 |
|
|---|
| 3075 | % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
|
|---|
| 3076 | % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
|
|---|
| 3077 | %
|
|---|
| 3078 | % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
|
|---|
| 3079 | % inside @code.
|
|---|
| 3080 | %
|
|---|
| 3081 | \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
|
|---|
| 3082 | \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
|
|---|
| 3083 |
|
|---|
| 3084 | % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
|
|---|
| 3085 | % #3 the target index (bar).
|
|---|
| 3086 | \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
|
|---|
| 3087 | % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
|
|---|
| 3088 | % closing the target index.
|
|---|
| 3089 | \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined
|
|---|
| 3090 | % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
|
|---|
| 3091 | % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
|
|---|
| 3092 | \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname
|
|---|
| 3093 | \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
|
|---|
| 3094 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3095 | % redefine \fooindfile:
|
|---|
| 3096 | \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
|
|---|
| 3097 | \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
|
|---|
| 3098 | % redefine \fooindex:
|
|---|
| 3099 | \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
|
|---|
| 3100 | }
|
|---|
| 3101 |
|
|---|
| 3102 | % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
|
|---|
| 3103 | % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
|
|---|
| 3104 | % and it is "foo", the name of the index.
|
|---|
| 3105 |
|
|---|
| 3106 | % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
|
|---|
| 3107 | % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
|
|---|
| 3108 |
|
|---|
| 3109 | % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
|
|---|
| 3110 | % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
|
|---|
| 3111 |
|
|---|
| 3112 | \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
|
|---|
| 3113 | \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
|
|---|
| 3114 |
|
|---|
| 3115 | % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
|
|---|
| 3116 | \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
|
|---|
| 3117 | \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
|
|---|
| 3118 |
|
|---|
| 3119 | % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
|
|---|
| 3120 | % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
|
|---|
| 3121 | % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
|
|---|
| 3122 | %
|
|---|
| 3123 | \def\indexdummies{%
|
|---|
| 3124 | \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
|
|---|
| 3125 | \def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
|
|---|
| 3126 | % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
|
|---|
| 3127 | % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
|
|---|
| 3128 | % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
|
|---|
| 3129 | \let\{ = \mylbrace
|
|---|
| 3130 | \let\} = \myrbrace
|
|---|
| 3131 | %
|
|---|
| 3132 | % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \realbackslash #1\space, thus
|
|---|
| 3133 | % effectively preventing its expansion. This is used only for control
|
|---|
| 3134 | % words, not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect
|
|---|
| 3135 | % for control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
|
|---|
| 3136 | % from whatever follows.
|
|---|
| 3137 | %
|
|---|
| 3138 | % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
|
|---|
| 3139 | % space.
|
|---|
| 3140 | %
|
|---|
| 3141 | % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
|
|---|
| 3142 | % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
|
|---|
| 3143 | % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
|
|---|
| 3144 | %
|
|---|
| 3145 | \def\definedummyword##1{%
|
|---|
| 3146 | \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1\space}%
|
|---|
| 3147 | }%
|
|---|
| 3148 | \def\definedummyletter##1{%
|
|---|
| 3149 | \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1}%
|
|---|
| 3150 | }%
|
|---|
| 3151 | \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
|
|---|
| 3152 | %
|
|---|
| 3153 | % Do the redefinitions.
|
|---|
| 3154 | \commondummies
|
|---|
| 3155 | }
|
|---|
| 3156 |
|
|---|
| 3157 | % For the aux file, @ is the escape character. So we want to redefine
|
|---|
| 3158 | % everything using @ instead of \realbackslash. When everything uses
|
|---|
| 3159 | % @, this will be simpler.
|
|---|
| 3160 | %
|
|---|
| 3161 | \def\atdummies{%
|
|---|
| 3162 | \def\@{@@}%
|
|---|
| 3163 | \def\ {@ }%
|
|---|
| 3164 | \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd
|
|---|
| 3165 | \let\} = \rbraceatcmd
|
|---|
| 3166 | %
|
|---|
| 3167 | % (See comments in \indexdummies.)
|
|---|
| 3168 | \def\definedummyword##1{%
|
|---|
| 3169 | \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{@##1\space}%
|
|---|
| 3170 | }%
|
|---|
| 3171 | \def\definedummyletter##1{%
|
|---|
| 3172 | \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{@##1}%
|
|---|
| 3173 | }%
|
|---|
| 3174 | \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
|
|---|
| 3175 | %
|
|---|
| 3176 | % Do the redefinitions.
|
|---|
| 3177 | \commondummies
|
|---|
| 3178 | }
|
|---|
| 3179 |
|
|---|
| 3180 | % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies. \definedummyword and
|
|---|
| 3181 | % \definedummyletter must be defined first.
|
|---|
| 3182 | %
|
|---|
| 3183 | \def\commondummies{%
|
|---|
| 3184 | %
|
|---|
| 3185 | \normalturnoffactive
|
|---|
| 3186 | %
|
|---|
| 3187 | \commondummiesnofonts
|
|---|
| 3188 | %
|
|---|
| 3189 | \definedummyletter{_}%
|
|---|
| 3190 | %
|
|---|
| 3191 | % Non-English letters.
|
|---|
| 3192 | \definedummyword{AA}%
|
|---|
| 3193 | \definedummyword{AE}%
|
|---|
| 3194 | \definedummyword{L}%
|
|---|
| 3195 | \definedummyword{OE}%
|
|---|
| 3196 | \definedummyword{O}%
|
|---|
| 3197 | \definedummyword{aa}%
|
|---|
| 3198 | \definedummyword{ae}%
|
|---|
| 3199 | \definedummyword{l}%
|
|---|
| 3200 | \definedummyword{oe}%
|
|---|
| 3201 | \definedummyword{o}%
|
|---|
| 3202 | \definedummyword{ss}%
|
|---|
| 3203 | \definedummyword{exclamdown}%
|
|---|
| 3204 | \definedummyword{questiondown}%
|
|---|
| 3205 | \definedummyword{ordf}%
|
|---|
| 3206 | \definedummyword{ordm}%
|
|---|
| 3207 | %
|
|---|
| 3208 | % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
|
|---|
| 3209 | \definedummyword{bf}%
|
|---|
| 3210 | \definedummyword{gtr}%
|
|---|
| 3211 | \definedummyword{hat}%
|
|---|
| 3212 | \definedummyword{less}%
|
|---|
| 3213 | \definedummyword{sf}%
|
|---|
| 3214 | \definedummyword{sl}%
|
|---|
| 3215 | \definedummyword{tclose}%
|
|---|
| 3216 | \definedummyword{tt}%
|
|---|
| 3217 | %
|
|---|
| 3218 | \definedummyword{LaTeX}%
|
|---|
| 3219 | \definedummyword{TeX}%
|
|---|
| 3220 | %
|
|---|
| 3221 | % Assorted special characters.
|
|---|
| 3222 | \definedummyword{bullet}%
|
|---|
| 3223 | \definedummyword{comma}%
|
|---|
| 3224 | \definedummyword{copyright}%
|
|---|
| 3225 | \definedummyword{registeredsymbol}%
|
|---|
| 3226 | \definedummyword{dots}%
|
|---|
| 3227 | \definedummyword{enddots}%
|
|---|
| 3228 | \definedummyword{equiv}%
|
|---|
| 3229 | \definedummyword{error}%
|
|---|
| 3230 | \definedummyword{euro}%
|
|---|
| 3231 | \definedummyword{expansion}%
|
|---|
| 3232 | \definedummyword{minus}%
|
|---|
| 3233 | \definedummyword{pounds}%
|
|---|
| 3234 | \definedummyword{point}%
|
|---|
| 3235 | \definedummyword{print}%
|
|---|
| 3236 | \definedummyword{result}%
|
|---|
| 3237 | %
|
|---|
| 3238 | % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
|
|---|
| 3239 | % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
|
|---|
| 3240 | \makevalueexpandable
|
|---|
| 3241 | %
|
|---|
| 3242 | % Normal spaces, not active ones.
|
|---|
| 3243 | \unsepspaces
|
|---|
| 3244 | %
|
|---|
| 3245 | % No macro expansion.
|
|---|
| 3246 | \turnoffmacros
|
|---|
| 3247 | }
|
|---|
| 3248 |
|
|---|
| 3249 | % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
|
|---|
| 3250 | %
|
|---|
| 3251 | % Better have this without active chars.
|
|---|
| 3252 | {
|
|---|
| 3253 | \catcode`\~=\other
|
|---|
| 3254 | \gdef\commondummiesnofonts{%
|
|---|
| 3255 | % Control letters and accents.
|
|---|
| 3256 | \definedummyletter{!}%
|
|---|
| 3257 | \definedummyaccent{"}%
|
|---|
| 3258 | \definedummyaccent{'}%
|
|---|
| 3259 | \definedummyletter{*}%
|
|---|
| 3260 | \definedummyaccent{,}%
|
|---|
| 3261 | \definedummyletter{.}%
|
|---|
| 3262 | \definedummyletter{/}%
|
|---|
| 3263 | \definedummyletter{:}%
|
|---|
| 3264 | \definedummyaccent{=}%
|
|---|
| 3265 | \definedummyletter{?}%
|
|---|
| 3266 | \definedummyaccent{^}%
|
|---|
| 3267 | \definedummyaccent{`}%
|
|---|
| 3268 | \definedummyaccent{~}%
|
|---|
| 3269 | \definedummyword{u}%
|
|---|
| 3270 | \definedummyword{v}%
|
|---|
| 3271 | \definedummyword{H}%
|
|---|
| 3272 | \definedummyword{dotaccent}%
|
|---|
| 3273 | \definedummyword{ringaccent}%
|
|---|
| 3274 | \definedummyword{tieaccent}%
|
|---|
| 3275 | \definedummyword{ubaraccent}%
|
|---|
| 3276 | \definedummyword{udotaccent}%
|
|---|
| 3277 | \definedummyword{dotless}%
|
|---|
| 3278 | %
|
|---|
| 3279 | % Texinfo font commands.
|
|---|
| 3280 | \definedummyword{b}%
|
|---|
| 3281 | \definedummyword{i}%
|
|---|
| 3282 | \definedummyword{r}%
|
|---|
| 3283 | \definedummyword{sc}%
|
|---|
| 3284 | \definedummyword{t}%
|
|---|
| 3285 | %
|
|---|
| 3286 | % Commands that take arguments.
|
|---|
| 3287 | \definedummyword{acronym}%
|
|---|
| 3288 | \definedummyword{cite}%
|
|---|
| 3289 | \definedummyword{code}%
|
|---|
| 3290 | \definedummyword{command}%
|
|---|
| 3291 | \definedummyword{dfn}%
|
|---|
| 3292 | \definedummyword{emph}%
|
|---|
| 3293 | \definedummyword{env}%
|
|---|
| 3294 | \definedummyword{file}%
|
|---|
| 3295 | \definedummyword{kbd}%
|
|---|
| 3296 | \definedummyword{key}%
|
|---|
| 3297 | \definedummyword{math}%
|
|---|
| 3298 | \definedummyword{option}%
|
|---|
| 3299 | \definedummyword{samp}%
|
|---|
| 3300 | \definedummyword{strong}%
|
|---|
| 3301 | \definedummyword{tie}%
|
|---|
| 3302 | \definedummyword{uref}%
|
|---|
| 3303 | \definedummyword{url}%
|
|---|
| 3304 | \definedummyword{var}%
|
|---|
| 3305 | \definedummyword{verb}%
|
|---|
| 3306 | \definedummyword{w}%
|
|---|
| 3307 | }
|
|---|
| 3308 | }
|
|---|
| 3309 |
|
|---|
| 3310 | % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
|
|---|
| 3311 | % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
|
|---|
| 3312 | % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
|
|---|
| 3313 | % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
|
|---|
| 3314 | %
|
|---|
| 3315 | \def\indexnofonts{%
|
|---|
| 3316 | % Accent commands should become @asis.
|
|---|
| 3317 | \def\definedummyaccent##1{%
|
|---|
| 3318 | \expandafter\let\csname ##1\endcsname\asis
|
|---|
| 3319 | }%
|
|---|
| 3320 | % We can just ignore other control letters.
|
|---|
| 3321 | \def\definedummyletter##1{%
|
|---|
| 3322 | \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{}%
|
|---|
| 3323 | }%
|
|---|
| 3324 | % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
|
|---|
| 3325 | \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
|
|---|
| 3326 | %
|
|---|
| 3327 | \commondummiesnofonts
|
|---|
| 3328 | %
|
|---|
| 3329 | % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
|
|---|
| 3330 | % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
|
|---|
| 3331 | % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
|
|---|
| 3332 | %\let\tt=\asis
|
|---|
| 3333 | %
|
|---|
| 3334 | \def\ { }%
|
|---|
| 3335 | \def\@{@}%
|
|---|
| 3336 | % how to handle braces?
|
|---|
| 3337 | \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
|
|---|
| 3338 | %
|
|---|
| 3339 | % Non-English letters.
|
|---|
| 3340 | \def\AA{AA}%
|
|---|
| 3341 | \def\AE{AE}%
|
|---|
| 3342 | \def\L{L}%
|
|---|
| 3343 | \def\OE{OE}%
|
|---|
| 3344 | \def\O{O}%
|
|---|
| 3345 | \def\aa{aa}%
|
|---|
| 3346 | \def\ae{ae}%
|
|---|
| 3347 | \def\l{l}%
|
|---|
| 3348 | \def\oe{oe}%
|
|---|
| 3349 | \def\o{o}%
|
|---|
| 3350 | \def\ss{ss}%
|
|---|
| 3351 | \def\exclamdown{!}%
|
|---|
| 3352 | \def\questiondown{?}%
|
|---|
| 3353 | \def\ordf{a}%
|
|---|
| 3354 | \def\ordm{o}%
|
|---|
| 3355 | %
|
|---|
| 3356 | \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
|
|---|
| 3357 | \def\TeX{TeX}%
|
|---|
| 3358 | %
|
|---|
| 3359 | % Assorted special characters.
|
|---|
| 3360 | % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
|
|---|
| 3361 | \def\bullet{bullet}%
|
|---|
| 3362 | \def\comma{,}%
|
|---|
| 3363 | \def\copyright{copyright}%
|
|---|
| 3364 | \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
|
|---|
| 3365 | \def\dots{...}%
|
|---|
| 3366 | \def\enddots{...}%
|
|---|
| 3367 | \def\equiv{==}%
|
|---|
| 3368 | \def\error{error}%
|
|---|
| 3369 | \def\euro{euro}%
|
|---|
| 3370 | \def\expansion{==>}%
|
|---|
| 3371 | \def\minus{-}%
|
|---|
| 3372 | \def\pounds{pounds}%
|
|---|
| 3373 | \def\point{.}%
|
|---|
| 3374 | \def\print{-|}%
|
|---|
| 3375 | \def\result{=>}%
|
|---|
| 3376 | %
|
|---|
| 3377 | % Don't write macro names.
|
|---|
| 3378 | \emptyusermacros
|
|---|
| 3379 | }
|
|---|
| 3380 |
|
|---|
| 3381 | \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
|
|---|
| 3382 | \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
|
|---|
| 3383 |
|
|---|
| 3384 | % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
|
|---|
| 3385 | % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
|
|---|
| 3386 | \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
|
|---|
| 3387 |
|
|---|
| 3388 | % Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
|
|---|
| 3389 | % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
|
|---|
| 3390 | % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
|
|---|
| 3391 | % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
|
|---|
| 3392 | %
|
|---|
| 3393 | \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
|
|---|
| 3394 | \iflinks
|
|---|
| 3395 | {%
|
|---|
| 3396 | % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
|
|---|
| 3397 | \toks0 = {#2}%
|
|---|
| 3398 | % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
|
|---|
| 3399 | \def\thirdarg{#3}%
|
|---|
| 3400 | \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
|
|---|
| 3401 | \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
|
|---|
| 3402 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3403 | %
|
|---|
| 3404 | \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
|
|---|
| 3405 | %
|
|---|
| 3406 | \ifvmode
|
|---|
| 3407 | \dosubindsanitize
|
|---|
| 3408 | \else
|
|---|
| 3409 | \dosubindwrite
|
|---|
| 3410 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3411 | }%
|
|---|
| 3412 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3413 | }
|
|---|
| 3414 |
|
|---|
| 3415 | % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
|
|---|
| 3416 | %
|
|---|
| 3417 | \def\dosubindwrite{%
|
|---|
| 3418 | % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
|
|---|
| 3419 | \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
|
|---|
| 3420 | \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
|
|---|
| 3421 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3422 | %
|
|---|
| 3423 | % Remember, we are within a group.
|
|---|
| 3424 | \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
|
|---|
| 3425 | \escapechar=`\\
|
|---|
| 3426 | \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
|
|---|
| 3427 | % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
|
|---|
| 3428 | %
|
|---|
| 3429 | % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
|
|---|
| 3430 | % get the string to sort by.
|
|---|
| 3431 | {\indexnofonts
|
|---|
| 3432 | \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
|
|---|
| 3433 | \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
|
|---|
| 3434 | }%
|
|---|
| 3435 | %
|
|---|
| 3436 | % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
|
|---|
| 3437 | % the original text, including any font commands. We write
|
|---|
| 3438 | % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
|
|---|
| 3439 | % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
|
|---|
| 3440 | % sorted result.
|
|---|
| 3441 | \edef\temp{%
|
|---|
| 3442 | \write\writeto{%
|
|---|
| 3443 | \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
|
|---|
| 3444 | }%
|
|---|
| 3445 | \temp
|
|---|
| 3446 | }
|
|---|
| 3447 |
|
|---|
| 3448 | % Take care of unwanted page breaks:
|
|---|
| 3449 | %
|
|---|
| 3450 | % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
|
|---|
| 3451 | % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
|
|---|
| 3452 | % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
|
|---|
| 3453 | % \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences
|
|---|
| 3454 | % like this:
|
|---|
| 3455 | % @end defun
|
|---|
| 3456 | % @tindex whatever
|
|---|
| 3457 | % @defun ...
|
|---|
| 3458 | % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
|
|---|
| 3459 | % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
|
|---|
| 3460 | % the previous defun.
|
|---|
| 3461 | %
|
|---|
| 3462 | % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
|
|---|
| 3463 | % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
|
|---|
| 3464 | %
|
|---|
| 3465 | % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
|
|---|
| 3466 | %
|
|---|
| 3467 | % But wait, there is a catch there:
|
|---|
| 3468 | % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
|
|---|
| 3469 | % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
|
|---|
| 3470 | % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
|
|---|
| 3471 | % representation of the skip.
|
|---|
| 3472 | %
|
|---|
| 3473 | % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
|
|---|
| 3474 | % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
|
|---|
| 3475 | %
|
|---|
| 3476 | \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
|
|---|
| 3477 | %
|
|---|
| 3478 | % ..., ready, GO:
|
|---|
| 3479 | %
|
|---|
| 3480 | \def\dosubindsanitize{%
|
|---|
| 3481 | % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
|
|---|
| 3482 | \skip0 = \lastskip
|
|---|
| 3483 | \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
|
|---|
| 3484 | \count255 = \lastpenalty
|
|---|
| 3485 | %
|
|---|
| 3486 | % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
|
|---|
| 3487 | % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
|
|---|
| 3488 | % -\skip0 glue we're inserting is preceded by a
|
|---|
| 3489 | % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
|
|---|
| 3490 | % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
|
|---|
| 3491 | \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
|
|---|
| 3492 | \else
|
|---|
| 3493 | \vskip-\skip0
|
|---|
| 3494 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3495 | %
|
|---|
| 3496 | \dosubindwrite
|
|---|
| 3497 | %
|
|---|
| 3498 | \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
|
|---|
| 3499 | % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
|
|---|
| 3500 | % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
|
|---|
| 3501 | % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
|
|---|
| 3502 | % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
|
|---|
| 3503 | % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
|
|---|
| 3504 | %
|
|---|
| 3505 | % @deffn deffn-whatever
|
|---|
| 3506 | % @vindex index-whatever
|
|---|
| 3507 | % Description.
|
|---|
| 3508 | % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
|
|---|
| 3509 | % and the "Description." paragraph.
|
|---|
| 3510 | \ifnum\count255>9999 \penalty\count255 \fi
|
|---|
| 3511 | \else
|
|---|
| 3512 | % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
|
|---|
| 3513 | % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
|
|---|
| 3514 | % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
|
|---|
| 3515 | \nobreak\vskip\skip0
|
|---|
| 3516 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3517 | }
|
|---|
| 3518 |
|
|---|
| 3519 | % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
|
|---|
| 3520 | % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
|
|---|
| 3521 | % or
|
|---|
| 3522 | % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
|
|---|
| 3523 | % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
|
|---|
| 3524 | % containing these kinds of lines:
|
|---|
| 3525 | % \initial {c}
|
|---|
| 3526 | % before the first topic whose initial is c
|
|---|
| 3527 | % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
|
|---|
| 3528 | % for a topic that is used without subtopics
|
|---|
| 3529 | % \primary {topic}
|
|---|
| 3530 | % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
|
|---|
| 3531 | % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
|
|---|
| 3532 | % for each subtopic.
|
|---|
| 3533 |
|
|---|
| 3534 | % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
|
|---|
| 3535 | % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
|
|---|
| 3536 |
|
|---|
| 3537 | \def\findex {\fnindex}
|
|---|
| 3538 | \def\kindex {\kyindex}
|
|---|
| 3539 | \def\cindex {\cpindex}
|
|---|
| 3540 | \def\vindex {\vrindex}
|
|---|
| 3541 | \def\tindex {\tpindex}
|
|---|
| 3542 | \def\pindex {\pgindex}
|
|---|
| 3543 |
|
|---|
| 3544 | \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
|
|---|
| 3545 | {\obeylines %
|
|---|
| 3546 | \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
|
|---|
| 3547 | \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
|
|---|
| 3548 |
|
|---|
| 3549 | % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
|
|---|
| 3550 |
|
|---|
| 3551 | % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
|
|---|
| 3552 | % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
|
|---|
| 3553 | %
|
|---|
| 3554 | \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 3555 | \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
|
|---|
| 3556 | %
|
|---|
| 3557 | \smallfonts \rm
|
|---|
| 3558 | \tolerance = 9500
|
|---|
| 3559 | \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
|
|---|
| 3560 | %
|
|---|
| 3561 | % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
|
|---|
| 3562 | % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
|
|---|
| 3563 | % \initial {@}
|
|---|
| 3564 | % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
|
|---|
| 3565 | % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
|
|---|
| 3566 | \catcode`\@ = 11
|
|---|
| 3567 | \openin 1 \jobname.#1s
|
|---|
| 3568 | \ifeof 1
|
|---|
| 3569 | % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
|
|---|
| 3570 | % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
|
|---|
| 3571 | % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
|
|---|
| 3572 | % there is some text.
|
|---|
| 3573 | \putwordIndexNonexistent
|
|---|
| 3574 | \else
|
|---|
| 3575 | %
|
|---|
| 3576 | % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
|
|---|
| 3577 | % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
|
|---|
| 3578 | % it can discover if there is anything in it.
|
|---|
| 3579 | \read 1 to \temp
|
|---|
| 3580 | \ifeof 1
|
|---|
| 3581 | \putwordIndexIsEmpty
|
|---|
| 3582 | \else
|
|---|
| 3583 | % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
|
|---|
| 3584 | % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
|
|---|
| 3585 | % to make right now.
|
|---|
| 3586 | \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
|
|---|
| 3587 | \catcode`\\ = 0
|
|---|
| 3588 | \escapechar = `\\
|
|---|
| 3589 | \begindoublecolumns
|
|---|
| 3590 | \input \jobname.#1s
|
|---|
| 3591 | \enddoublecolumns
|
|---|
| 3592 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3593 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3594 | \closein 1
|
|---|
| 3595 | \endgroup}
|
|---|
| 3596 |
|
|---|
| 3597 | % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
|
|---|
| 3598 | % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
|
|---|
| 3599 |
|
|---|
| 3600 | \def\initial#1{{%
|
|---|
| 3601 | % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
|
|---|
| 3602 | \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt
|
|---|
| 3603 | %
|
|---|
| 3604 | % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
|
|---|
| 3605 | \removelastskip
|
|---|
| 3606 | %
|
|---|
| 3607 | % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
|
|---|
| 3608 | \nobreak
|
|---|
| 3609 | \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 3610 | \penalty 0
|
|---|
| 3611 | \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 3612 | %
|
|---|
| 3613 | % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
|
|---|
| 3614 | % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
|
|---|
| 3615 | % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
|
|---|
| 3616 | % we need before each entry, but it's better.
|
|---|
| 3617 | %
|
|---|
| 3618 | % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
|
|---|
| 3619 | \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 3620 | \leftline{\secbf #1}%
|
|---|
| 3621 | % Do our best not to break after the initial.
|
|---|
| 3622 | \nobreak
|
|---|
| 3623 | \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 3624 | }}
|
|---|
| 3625 |
|
|---|
| 3626 | % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
|
|---|
| 3627 | % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
|
|---|
| 3628 | % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
|
|---|
| 3629 | %
|
|---|
| 3630 | % A straightforward implementation would start like this:
|
|---|
| 3631 | % \def\entry#1#2{...
|
|---|
| 3632 | % But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
|
|---|
| 3633 | % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
|
|---|
| 3634 | % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
|
|---|
| 3635 | %
|
|---|
| 3636 | % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
|
|---|
| 3637 | % --kasal, 21nov03
|
|---|
| 3638 | \def\entry{%
|
|---|
| 3639 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 3640 | %
|
|---|
| 3641 | % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
|
|---|
| 3642 | % affect previous text.
|
|---|
| 3643 | \par
|
|---|
| 3644 | %
|
|---|
| 3645 | % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
|
|---|
| 3646 | \parfillskip = 0in
|
|---|
| 3647 | %
|
|---|
| 3648 | % No extra space above this paragraph.
|
|---|
| 3649 | \parskip = 0in
|
|---|
| 3650 | %
|
|---|
| 3651 | % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
|
|---|
| 3652 | \finalhyphendemerits = 0
|
|---|
| 3653 | %
|
|---|
| 3654 | % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
|
|---|
| 3655 | % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
|
|---|
| 3656 | % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
|
|---|
| 3657 | % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
|
|---|
| 3658 | % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
|
|---|
| 3659 | %
|
|---|
| 3660 | % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
|
|---|
| 3661 | % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
|
|---|
| 3662 | \hangindent = 2em
|
|---|
| 3663 | %
|
|---|
| 3664 | % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
|
|---|
| 3665 | % with blank space.
|
|---|
| 3666 | \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
|
|---|
| 3667 | %
|
|---|
| 3668 | % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
|
|---|
| 3669 | % columns.
|
|---|
| 3670 | \vskip 0pt plus1pt
|
|---|
| 3671 | %
|
|---|
| 3672 | % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
|
|---|
| 3673 | \afterassignment\doentry
|
|---|
| 3674 | \let\temp =
|
|---|
| 3675 | }
|
|---|
| 3676 | \def\doentry{%
|
|---|
| 3677 | \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
|
|---|
| 3678 | \noindent
|
|---|
| 3679 | \aftergroup\finishentry
|
|---|
| 3680 | % And now comes the text of the entry.
|
|---|
| 3681 | }
|
|---|
| 3682 | \def\finishentry#1{%
|
|---|
| 3683 | % #1 is the page number.
|
|---|
| 3684 | %
|
|---|
| 3685 | % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
|
|---|
| 3686 | % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
|
|---|
| 3687 | % cursed by a Unix daemon.
|
|---|
| 3688 | \def\tempa{{\rm }}%
|
|---|
| 3689 | \def\tempb{#1}%
|
|---|
| 3690 | \edef\tempc{\tempa}%
|
|---|
| 3691 | \edef\tempd{\tempb}%
|
|---|
| 3692 | \ifx\tempc\tempd
|
|---|
| 3693 | \ %
|
|---|
| 3694 | \else
|
|---|
| 3695 | %
|
|---|
| 3696 | % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
|
|---|
| 3697 | % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
|
|---|
| 3698 | % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
|
|---|
| 3699 | \hfil\penalty50
|
|---|
| 3700 | \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
|
|---|
| 3701 | %
|
|---|
| 3702 | % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
|
|---|
| 3703 | % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
|
|---|
| 3704 | % \hbox ensues.
|
|---|
| 3705 | \ifpdf
|
|---|
| 3706 | \pdfgettoks#1.%
|
|---|
| 3707 | \ \the\toksA
|
|---|
| 3708 | \else
|
|---|
| 3709 | \ #1%
|
|---|
| 3710 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3711 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3712 | \par
|
|---|
| 3713 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 3714 | }
|
|---|
| 3715 |
|
|---|
| 3716 | % Like \dotfill except takes at least 1 em.
|
|---|
| 3717 | \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
|
|---|
| 3718 | \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu ${\it .}$ \mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
|
|---|
| 3719 |
|
|---|
| 3720 | \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
|
|---|
| 3721 |
|
|---|
| 3722 | \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
|
|---|
| 3723 | \def\secondary#1#2{{%
|
|---|
| 3724 | \parfillskip=0in
|
|---|
| 3725 | \parskip=0in
|
|---|
| 3726 | \hangindent=1in
|
|---|
| 3727 | \hangafter=1
|
|---|
| 3728 | \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
|
|---|
| 3729 | \ifpdf
|
|---|
| 3730 | \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
|
|---|
| 3731 | \else
|
|---|
| 3732 | #2
|
|---|
| 3733 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3734 | \par
|
|---|
| 3735 | }}
|
|---|
| 3736 |
|
|---|
| 3737 | % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
|
|---|
| 3738 | % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
|
|---|
| 3739 | % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
|
|---|
| 3740 | \catcode`\@=11
|
|---|
| 3741 |
|
|---|
| 3742 | \newbox\partialpage
|
|---|
| 3743 | \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
|
|---|
| 3744 |
|
|---|
| 3745 | \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
|
|---|
| 3746 | % Grab any single-column material above us.
|
|---|
| 3747 | \output = {%
|
|---|
| 3748 | %
|
|---|
| 3749 | % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
|
|---|
| 3750 | % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
|
|---|
| 3751 | % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
|
|---|
| 3752 | % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
|
|---|
| 3753 | % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
|
|---|
| 3754 | % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
|
|---|
| 3755 | % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
|
|---|
| 3756 | \ifvoid\partialpage \else
|
|---|
| 3757 | \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
|
|---|
| 3758 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3759 | %
|
|---|
| 3760 | \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
|
|---|
| 3761 | % Unvbox the main output page.
|
|---|
| 3762 | \unvbox\PAGE
|
|---|
| 3763 | \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 3764 | }%
|
|---|
| 3765 | }%
|
|---|
| 3766 | \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
|
|---|
| 3767 | %
|
|---|
| 3768 | % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
|
|---|
| 3769 | \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
|
|---|
| 3770 | %
|
|---|
| 3771 | % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
|
|---|
| 3772 | % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
|
|---|
| 3773 | % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
|
|---|
| 3774 | % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
|
|---|
| 3775 | % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
|
|---|
| 3776 | %
|
|---|
| 3777 | % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
|
|---|
| 3778 | % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
|
|---|
| 3779 | % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
|
|---|
| 3780 | % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
|
|---|
| 3781 | % as it did when we hard-coded it.
|
|---|
| 3782 | %
|
|---|
| 3783 | % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
|
|---|
| 3784 | % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
|
|---|
| 3785 | % been clobbered.
|
|---|
| 3786 | %
|
|---|
| 3787 | \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
|
|---|
| 3788 | \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
|
|---|
| 3789 | \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
|
|---|
| 3790 | \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
|
|---|
| 3791 | %
|
|---|
| 3792 | % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
|
|---|
| 3793 | % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
|
|---|
| 3794 | \vsize = 2\vsize
|
|---|
| 3795 | }
|
|---|
| 3796 |
|
|---|
| 3797 | % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
|
|---|
| 3798 | % the last.
|
|---|
| 3799 | %
|
|---|
| 3800 | \def\doublecolumnout{%
|
|---|
| 3801 | \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
|
|---|
| 3802 | % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
|
|---|
| 3803 | % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
|
|---|
| 3804 | % previous page.
|
|---|
| 3805 | \dimen@ = \vsize
|
|---|
| 3806 | \divide\dimen@ by 2
|
|---|
| 3807 | \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage
|
|---|
| 3808 | %
|
|---|
| 3809 | % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
|
|---|
| 3810 | \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@
|
|---|
| 3811 | \onepageout\pagesofar
|
|---|
| 3812 | \unvbox255
|
|---|
| 3813 | \penalty\outputpenalty
|
|---|
| 3814 | }
|
|---|
| 3815 | %
|
|---|
| 3816 | % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
|
|---|
| 3817 | % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
|
|---|
| 3818 | \def\pagesofar{%
|
|---|
| 3819 | \unvbox\partialpage
|
|---|
| 3820 | %
|
|---|
| 3821 | \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
|
|---|
| 3822 | \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
|
|---|
| 3823 | \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
|
|---|
| 3824 | }
|
|---|
| 3825 | %
|
|---|
| 3826 | % All done with double columns.
|
|---|
| 3827 | \def\enddoublecolumns{%
|
|---|
| 3828 | \output = {%
|
|---|
| 3829 | % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
|
|---|
| 3830 | % current page, no automatic page break.
|
|---|
| 3831 | \balancecolumns
|
|---|
| 3832 | %
|
|---|
| 3833 | % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
|
|---|
| 3834 | % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
|
|---|
| 3835 | % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
|
|---|
| 3836 | % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
|
|---|
| 3837 | % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
|
|---|
| 3838 | % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
|
|---|
| 3839 | % the output somewhat more palatable.)
|
|---|
| 3840 | \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
|
|---|
| 3841 | }%
|
|---|
| 3842 | \eject
|
|---|
| 3843 | \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
|
|---|
| 3844 | %
|
|---|
| 3845 | % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
|
|---|
| 3846 | % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
|
|---|
| 3847 | % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
|
|---|
| 3848 | % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
|
|---|
| 3849 | \pagegoal = \vsize
|
|---|
| 3850 | }
|
|---|
| 3851 | %
|
|---|
| 3852 | % Called at the end of the double column material.
|
|---|
| 3853 | \def\balancecolumns{%
|
|---|
| 3854 | \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
|
|---|
| 3855 | \dimen@ = \ht0
|
|---|
| 3856 | \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
|
|---|
| 3857 | \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 3858 | \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
|
|---|
| 3859 | %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
|
|---|
| 3860 | \splittopskip = \topskip
|
|---|
| 3861 | % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
|
|---|
| 3862 | {%
|
|---|
| 3863 | \vbadness = 10000
|
|---|
| 3864 | \loop
|
|---|
| 3865 | \global\setbox3 = \copy0
|
|---|
| 3866 | \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
|
|---|
| 3867 | \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@
|
|---|
| 3868 | \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
|
|---|
| 3869 | \repeat
|
|---|
| 3870 | }%
|
|---|
| 3871 | %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
|
|---|
| 3872 | \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}%
|
|---|
| 3873 | \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}%
|
|---|
| 3874 | %
|
|---|
| 3875 | \pagesofar
|
|---|
| 3876 | }
|
|---|
| 3877 | \catcode`\@ = \other
|
|---|
| 3878 |
|
|---|
| 3879 |
|
|---|
| 3880 | \message{sectioning,}
|
|---|
| 3881 | % Chapters, sections, etc.
|
|---|
| 3882 |
|
|---|
| 3883 | % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered
|
|---|
| 3884 | % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
|
|---|
| 3885 | % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
|
|---|
| 3886 | % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
|
|---|
| 3887 | % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
|
|---|
| 3888 | \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
|
|---|
| 3889 | \newcount\chapno
|
|---|
| 3890 | \newcount\secno \secno=0
|
|---|
| 3891 | \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
|
|---|
| 3892 | \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
|
|---|
| 3893 |
|
|---|
| 3894 | % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
|
|---|
| 3895 | \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
|
|---|
| 3896 | %
|
|---|
| 3897 | % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
|
|---|
| 3898 | % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
|
|---|
| 3899 | % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
|
|---|
| 3900 | % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
|
|---|
| 3901 | %
|
|---|
| 3902 | \def\appendixletter{%
|
|---|
| 3903 | \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
|
|---|
| 3904 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
|
|---|
| 3905 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
|
|---|
| 3906 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
|
|---|
| 3907 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
|
|---|
| 3908 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
|
|---|
| 3909 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
|
|---|
| 3910 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
|
|---|
| 3911 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
|
|---|
| 3912 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
|
|---|
| 3913 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
|
|---|
| 3914 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
|
|---|
| 3915 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
|
|---|
| 3916 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
|
|---|
| 3917 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
|
|---|
| 3918 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
|
|---|
| 3919 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
|
|---|
| 3920 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
|
|---|
| 3921 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
|
|---|
| 3922 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
|
|---|
| 3923 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
|
|---|
| 3924 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
|
|---|
| 3925 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
|
|---|
| 3926 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
|
|---|
| 3927 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
|
|---|
| 3928 | \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
|
|---|
| 3929 | % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
|
|---|
| 3930 | % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
|
|---|
| 3931 | % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
|
|---|
| 3932 | % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
|
|---|
| 3933 | \else\char\the\appendixno
|
|---|
| 3934 | \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
|
|---|
| 3935 | \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
|
|---|
| 3936 |
|
|---|
| 3937 | % Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter.
|
|---|
| 3938 | % page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise.
|
|---|
| 3939 | % However, they are not reliable, because we don't use marks.
|
|---|
| 3940 | \def\thischapter{}
|
|---|
| 3941 | \def\thissection{}
|
|---|
| 3942 |
|
|---|
| 3943 | \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
|
|---|
| 3944 | \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
|
|---|
| 3945 |
|
|---|
| 3946 | % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
|
|---|
| 3947 | \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
|
|---|
| 3948 | \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
|
|---|
| 3949 |
|
|---|
| 3950 | % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
|
|---|
| 3951 | \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
|
|---|
| 3952 | \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
|
|---|
| 3953 |
|
|---|
| 3954 | % we only have subsub.
|
|---|
| 3955 | \chardef\maxseclevel = 3
|
|---|
| 3956 | %
|
|---|
| 3957 | % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
|
|---|
| 3958 | % To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
|
|---|
| 3959 | \chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel
|
|---|
| 3960 | %
|
|---|
| 3961 | % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
|
|---|
| 3962 | % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
|
|---|
| 3963 | \def\chapheadtype{N}
|
|---|
| 3964 |
|
|---|
| 3965 | % Choose a heading macro
|
|---|
| 3966 | % #1 is heading type
|
|---|
| 3967 | % #2 is heading level
|
|---|
| 3968 | % #3 is text for heading
|
|---|
| 3969 | \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
|
|---|
| 3970 | % Compute the abs. sec. level:
|
|---|
| 3971 | \absseclevel=#2
|
|---|
| 3972 | \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
|
|---|
| 3973 | % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
|
|---|
| 3974 | \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
|
|---|
| 3975 | \absseclevel = 0
|
|---|
| 3976 | \else
|
|---|
| 3977 | \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
|
|---|
| 3978 | \absseclevel = 3
|
|---|
| 3979 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3980 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3981 | % The heading type:
|
|---|
| 3982 | \def\headtype{#1}%
|
|---|
| 3983 | \if \headtype U%
|
|---|
| 3984 | \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel
|
|---|
| 3985 | \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel
|
|---|
| 3986 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3987 | \else
|
|---|
| 3988 | % Check for appendix sections:
|
|---|
| 3989 | \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
|
|---|
| 3990 | \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
|
|---|
| 3991 | \else
|
|---|
| 3992 | \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
|
|---|
| 3993 | \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
|
|---|
| 3994 | \fi\fi
|
|---|
| 3995 | \fi
|
|---|
| 3996 | % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
|
|---|
| 3997 | \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel
|
|---|
| 3998 | \def\headtype{U}%
|
|---|
| 3999 | \else
|
|---|
| 4000 | \chardef\unmlevel = 3
|
|---|
| 4001 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4002 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4003 | % Now print the heading:
|
|---|
| 4004 | \if \headtype U%
|
|---|
| 4005 | \ifcase\absseclevel
|
|---|
| 4006 | \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4007 | \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4008 | \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4009 | \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4010 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4011 | \else
|
|---|
| 4012 | \if \headtype A%
|
|---|
| 4013 | \ifcase\absseclevel
|
|---|
| 4014 | \appendixzzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4015 | \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4016 | \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4017 | \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4018 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4019 | \else
|
|---|
| 4020 | \ifcase\absseclevel
|
|---|
| 4021 | \chapterzzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4022 | \or \seczzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4023 | \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4024 | \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4025 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4026 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4027 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4028 | \suppressfirstparagraphindent
|
|---|
| 4029 | }
|
|---|
| 4030 |
|
|---|
| 4031 | % an interface:
|
|---|
| 4032 | \def\numhead{\genhead N}
|
|---|
| 4033 | \def\apphead{\genhead A}
|
|---|
| 4034 | \def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
|
|---|
| 4035 |
|
|---|
| 4036 | % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
|
|---|
| 4037 | % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
|
|---|
| 4038 | %
|
|---|
| 4039 | % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
|
|---|
| 4040 | % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
|
|---|
| 4041 | \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
|
|---|
| 4042 | %
|
|---|
| 4043 | \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
|
|---|
| 4044 | \def\chapterzzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4045 | % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
|
|---|
| 4046 | % as an @include file.
|
|---|
| 4047 | \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
|
|---|
| 4048 | \global\advance\chapno by 1
|
|---|
| 4049 | %
|
|---|
| 4050 | % Used for \float.
|
|---|
| 4051 | \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
|
|---|
| 4052 | \resetallfloatnos
|
|---|
| 4053 | %
|
|---|
| 4054 | \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
|
|---|
| 4055 | %
|
|---|
| 4056 | % Write the actual heading.
|
|---|
| 4057 | \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
|
|---|
| 4058 | %
|
|---|
| 4059 | % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
|
|---|
| 4060 | \global\let\section = \numberedsec
|
|---|
| 4061 | \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
|
|---|
| 4062 | \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
|
|---|
| 4063 | }
|
|---|
| 4064 |
|
|---|
| 4065 | \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
|
|---|
| 4066 | \def\appendixzzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4067 | \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
|
|---|
| 4068 | \global\advance\appendixno by 1
|
|---|
| 4069 | \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
|
|---|
| 4070 | \resetallfloatnos
|
|---|
| 4071 | %
|
|---|
| 4072 | \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
|
|---|
| 4073 | \message{\appendixnum}%
|
|---|
| 4074 | %
|
|---|
| 4075 | \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
|
|---|
| 4076 | %
|
|---|
| 4077 | \global\let\section = \appendixsec
|
|---|
| 4078 | \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
|
|---|
| 4079 | \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
|
|---|
| 4080 | }
|
|---|
| 4081 |
|
|---|
| 4082 | \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
|
|---|
| 4083 | \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4084 | \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
|
|---|
| 4085 | \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
|
|---|
| 4086 | %
|
|---|
| 4087 | % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
|
|---|
| 4088 | \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
|
|---|
| 4089 | \resetallfloatnos
|
|---|
| 4090 | %
|
|---|
| 4091 | % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
|
|---|
| 4092 | % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
|
|---|
| 4093 | % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
|
|---|
| 4094 | % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
|
|---|
| 4095 | % to be executed, not expanded).
|
|---|
| 4096 | %
|
|---|
| 4097 | % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
|
|---|
| 4098 | % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
|
|---|
| 4099 | % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
|
|---|
| 4100 | % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
|
|---|
| 4101 | % the toc entries.)
|
|---|
| 4102 | \toks0 = {#1}%
|
|---|
| 4103 | \message{(\the\toks0)}%
|
|---|
| 4104 | %
|
|---|
| 4105 | \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
|
|---|
| 4106 | %
|
|---|
| 4107 | \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
|
|---|
| 4108 | \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
|
|---|
| 4109 | \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
|
|---|
| 4110 | }
|
|---|
| 4111 |
|
|---|
| 4112 | % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
|
|---|
| 4113 | \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
|
|---|
| 4114 | % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
|
|---|
| 4115 | % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
|
|---|
| 4116 | % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
|
|---|
| 4117 | \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
|
|---|
| 4118 | \unnmhead0{#1}%
|
|---|
| 4119 | \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
|
|---|
| 4120 | }
|
|---|
| 4121 |
|
|---|
| 4122 | % @top is like @unnumbered.
|
|---|
| 4123 | \let\top\unnumbered
|
|---|
| 4124 |
|
|---|
| 4125 | % Sections.
|
|---|
| 4126 | \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
|
|---|
| 4127 | \def\seczzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4128 | \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
|
|---|
| 4129 | \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
|
|---|
| 4130 | }
|
|---|
| 4131 |
|
|---|
| 4132 | \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
|
|---|
| 4133 | \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4134 | \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
|
|---|
| 4135 | \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
|
|---|
| 4136 | }
|
|---|
| 4137 | \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
|
|---|
| 4138 |
|
|---|
| 4139 | \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
|
|---|
| 4140 | \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4141 | \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
|
|---|
| 4142 | \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
|
|---|
| 4143 | }
|
|---|
| 4144 |
|
|---|
| 4145 | % Subsections.
|
|---|
| 4146 | \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
|
|---|
| 4147 | \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4148 | \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
|
|---|
| 4149 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
|
|---|
| 4150 | }
|
|---|
| 4151 |
|
|---|
| 4152 | \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
|
|---|
| 4153 | \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4154 | \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
|
|---|
| 4155 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
|
|---|
| 4156 | {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
|
|---|
| 4157 | }
|
|---|
| 4158 |
|
|---|
| 4159 | \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
|
|---|
| 4160 | \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4161 | \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
|
|---|
| 4162 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
|
|---|
| 4163 | {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
|
|---|
| 4164 | }
|
|---|
| 4165 |
|
|---|
| 4166 | % Subsubsections.
|
|---|
| 4167 | \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
|
|---|
| 4168 | \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4169 | \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
|
|---|
| 4170 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
|
|---|
| 4171 | {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
|
|---|
| 4172 | }
|
|---|
| 4173 |
|
|---|
| 4174 | \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
|
|---|
| 4175 | \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4176 | \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
|
|---|
| 4177 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
|
|---|
| 4178 | {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
|
|---|
| 4179 | }
|
|---|
| 4180 |
|
|---|
| 4181 | \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
|
|---|
| 4182 | \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4183 | \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
|
|---|
| 4184 | \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
|
|---|
| 4185 | {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
|
|---|
| 4186 | }
|
|---|
| 4187 |
|
|---|
| 4188 | % These macros control what the section commands do, according
|
|---|
| 4189 | % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
|
|---|
| 4190 | % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
|
|---|
| 4191 | \let\section = \numberedsec
|
|---|
| 4192 | \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
|
|---|
| 4193 | \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
|
|---|
| 4194 |
|
|---|
| 4195 | % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
|
|---|
| 4196 |
|
|---|
| 4197 | % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such:
|
|---|
| 4198 | % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
|
|---|
| 4199 | % overlong headings to fold.
|
|---|
| 4200 | % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
|
|---|
| 4201 | % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
|
|---|
| 4202 | % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
|
|---|
| 4203 | % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
|
|---|
| 4204 |
|
|---|
| 4205 |
|
|---|
| 4206 | \def\majorheading{%
|
|---|
| 4207 | {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
|
|---|
| 4208 | \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
|
|---|
| 4209 | }
|
|---|
| 4210 |
|
|---|
| 4211 | \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
|
|---|
| 4212 | \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
|
|---|
| 4213 | {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
|
|---|
| 4214 | \parindent=0pt\raggedright
|
|---|
| 4215 | \rm #1\hfill}}%
|
|---|
| 4216 | \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
|
|---|
| 4217 | \suppressfirstparagraphindent
|
|---|
| 4218 | }
|
|---|
| 4219 |
|
|---|
| 4220 | % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
|
|---|
| 4221 | \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
|
|---|
| 4222 | \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
|
|---|
| 4223 | \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
|
|---|
| 4224 | \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
|
|---|
| 4225 | \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
|
|---|
| 4226 | \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
|
|---|
| 4227 |
|
|---|
| 4228 | % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
|
|---|
| 4229 | % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
|
|---|
| 4230 | % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
|
|---|
| 4231 |
|
|---|
| 4232 | %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
|
|---|
| 4233 | \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
|
|---|
| 4234 |
|
|---|
| 4235 | %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
|
|---|
| 4236 | % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
|
|---|
| 4237 |
|
|---|
| 4238 | \newskip\chapheadingskip
|
|---|
| 4239 |
|
|---|
| 4240 | \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
|
|---|
| 4241 | \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
|
|---|
| 4242 | \def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi}
|
|---|
| 4243 |
|
|---|
| 4244 | \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
|
|---|
| 4245 |
|
|---|
| 4246 | \def\CHAPPAGoff{%
|
|---|
| 4247 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
|
|---|
| 4248 | \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
|
|---|
| 4249 | \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
|
|---|
| 4250 |
|
|---|
| 4251 | \def\CHAPPAGon{%
|
|---|
| 4252 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
|
|---|
| 4253 | \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
|
|---|
| 4254 | \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
|
|---|
| 4255 | \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
|
|---|
| 4256 |
|
|---|
| 4257 | \def\CHAPPAGodd{%
|
|---|
| 4258 | \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
|
|---|
| 4259 | \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
|
|---|
| 4260 | \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
|
|---|
| 4261 | \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
|
|---|
| 4262 |
|
|---|
| 4263 | \CHAPPAGon
|
|---|
| 4264 |
|
|---|
| 4265 | % Chapter opening.
|
|---|
| 4266 | %
|
|---|
| 4267 | % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
|
|---|
| 4268 | % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
|
|---|
| 4269 | %
|
|---|
| 4270 | % To test against our argument.
|
|---|
| 4271 | \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
|
|---|
| 4272 | \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
|
|---|
| 4273 | \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
|
|---|
| 4274 | %
|
|---|
| 4275 | \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
|
|---|
| 4276 | \pchapsepmacro
|
|---|
| 4277 | {%
|
|---|
| 4278 | \chapfonts \rm
|
|---|
| 4279 | %
|
|---|
| 4280 | % Have to define \thissection before calling \donoderef, because the
|
|---|
| 4281 | % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
|
|---|
| 4282 | % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
|
|---|
| 4283 | \gdef\thissection{#1}%
|
|---|
| 4284 | \gdef\thischaptername{#1}%
|
|---|
| 4285 | %
|
|---|
| 4286 | % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
|
|---|
| 4287 | % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
|
|---|
| 4288 | \def\temptype{#2}%
|
|---|
| 4289 | \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
|
|---|
| 4290 | \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
|
|---|
| 4291 | \def\toctype{unnchap}%
|
|---|
| 4292 | \def\thischapter{#1}%
|
|---|
| 4293 | \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
|
|---|
| 4294 | \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
|
|---|
| 4295 | \def\toctype{omit}%
|
|---|
| 4296 | \xdef\thischapter{}%
|
|---|
| 4297 | \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
|
|---|
| 4298 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
|
|---|
| 4299 | \def\toctype{app}%
|
|---|
| 4300 | % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter
|
|---|
| 4301 | % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. And we don't
|
|---|
| 4302 | % use \thissection because that changes with each section.
|
|---|
| 4303 | %
|
|---|
| 4304 | \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter:
|
|---|
| 4305 | \noexpand\thischaptername}%
|
|---|
| 4306 | \else
|
|---|
| 4307 | \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
|
|---|
| 4308 | \def\toctype{numchap}%
|
|---|
| 4309 | \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno:
|
|---|
| 4310 | \noexpand\thischaptername}%
|
|---|
| 4311 | \fi\fi\fi
|
|---|
| 4312 | %
|
|---|
| 4313 | % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
|
|---|
| 4314 | % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
|
|---|
| 4315 | % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
|
|---|
| 4316 | \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4317 | %
|
|---|
| 4318 | % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
|
|---|
| 4319 | % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
|
|---|
| 4320 | % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
|
|---|
| 4321 | % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
|
|---|
| 4322 | % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
|
|---|
| 4323 | \donoderef{#2}%
|
|---|
| 4324 | %
|
|---|
| 4325 | % Typeset the actual heading.
|
|---|
| 4326 | \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
|
|---|
| 4327 | \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
|
|---|
| 4328 | \unhbox0 #1\par}%
|
|---|
| 4329 | }%
|
|---|
| 4330 | \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
|
|---|
| 4331 | \nobreak
|
|---|
| 4332 | }
|
|---|
| 4333 |
|
|---|
| 4334 | % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
|
|---|
| 4335 | \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
|
|---|
| 4336 | \def\centerparameters{%
|
|---|
| 4337 | \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
|
|---|
| 4338 | \leftskip = \rightskip
|
|---|
| 4339 | \parfillskip = 0pt
|
|---|
| 4340 | }
|
|---|
| 4341 |
|
|---|
| 4342 |
|
|---|
| 4343 | % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
|
|---|
| 4344 | % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
|
|---|
| 4345 | %
|
|---|
| 4346 | \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
|
|---|
| 4347 | %
|
|---|
| 4348 | \def\unnchfopen #1{%
|
|---|
| 4349 | \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
|
|---|
| 4350 | \parindent=0pt\raggedright
|
|---|
| 4351 | \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
|
|---|
| 4352 | }
|
|---|
| 4353 | \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
|
|---|
| 4354 | \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
|
|---|
| 4355 | \par\penalty 5000 %
|
|---|
| 4356 | }
|
|---|
| 4357 | \def\centerchfopen #1{%
|
|---|
| 4358 | \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
|
|---|
| 4359 | \parindent=0pt
|
|---|
| 4360 | \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
|
|---|
| 4361 | }
|
|---|
| 4362 | \def\CHAPFopen{%
|
|---|
| 4363 | \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
|
|---|
| 4364 | \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
|
|---|
| 4365 |
|
|---|
| 4366 |
|
|---|
| 4367 | % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
|
|---|
| 4368 | % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
|
|---|
| 4369 | %
|
|---|
| 4370 | \newskip\secheadingskip
|
|---|
| 4371 | \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
|
|---|
| 4372 |
|
|---|
| 4373 | % Subsection titles.
|
|---|
| 4374 | \newskip\subsecheadingskip
|
|---|
| 4375 | \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
|
|---|
| 4376 |
|
|---|
| 4377 | % Subsubsection titles.
|
|---|
| 4378 | \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
|
|---|
| 4379 | \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
|
|---|
| 4380 |
|
|---|
| 4381 |
|
|---|
| 4382 | % Print any size, any type, section title.
|
|---|
| 4383 | %
|
|---|
| 4384 | % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
|
|---|
| 4385 | % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
|
|---|
| 4386 | % section number.
|
|---|
| 4387 | %
|
|---|
| 4388 | \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
|
|---|
| 4389 | {%
|
|---|
| 4390 | % Switch to the right set of fonts.
|
|---|
| 4391 | \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
|
|---|
| 4392 | %
|
|---|
| 4393 | % Insert space above the heading.
|
|---|
| 4394 | \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
|
|---|
| 4395 | %
|
|---|
| 4396 | % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
|
|---|
| 4397 | \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
|
|---|
| 4398 | \def\temptype{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4399 | %
|
|---|
| 4400 | \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
|
|---|
| 4401 | \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
|
|---|
| 4402 | \def\toctype{unn}%
|
|---|
| 4403 | \gdef\thissection{#1}%
|
|---|
| 4404 | \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
|
|---|
| 4405 | % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
|
|---|
| 4406 | % and don't redefine \thissection.
|
|---|
| 4407 | \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
|
|---|
| 4408 | \def\toctype{omit}%
|
|---|
| 4409 | \let\sectionlevel=\empty
|
|---|
| 4410 | \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
|
|---|
| 4411 | \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
|
|---|
| 4412 | \def\toctype{app}%
|
|---|
| 4413 | \gdef\thissection{#1}%
|
|---|
| 4414 | \else
|
|---|
| 4415 | \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
|
|---|
| 4416 | \def\toctype{num}%
|
|---|
| 4417 | \gdef\thissection{#1}%
|
|---|
| 4418 | \fi\fi\fi
|
|---|
| 4419 | %
|
|---|
| 4420 | % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chfplain.
|
|---|
| 4421 | \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
|
|---|
| 4422 | %
|
|---|
| 4423 | % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
|
|---|
| 4424 | % Again, see comments in \chfplain.
|
|---|
| 4425 | \donoderef{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4426 | %
|
|---|
| 4427 | % Output the actual section heading.
|
|---|
| 4428 | \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
|
|---|
| 4429 | \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
|
|---|
| 4430 | \unhbox0 #1}%
|
|---|
| 4431 | }%
|
|---|
| 4432 | % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
|
|---|
| 4433 | % Don't allow stretch, though.
|
|---|
| 4434 | \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
|
|---|
| 4435 | %
|
|---|
| 4436 | % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
|
|---|
| 4437 | % was followed by glue.
|
|---|
| 4438 | \nobreak
|
|---|
| 4439 | %
|
|---|
| 4440 | % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
|
|---|
| 4441 | % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
|
|---|
| 4442 | % discardable item.)
|
|---|
| 4443 | \vskip-\parskip
|
|---|
| 4444 | %
|
|---|
| 4445 | % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
|
|---|
| 4446 | % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
|
|---|
| 4447 | % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
|
|---|
| 4448 | %
|
|---|
| 4449 | % @section sec-whatever
|
|---|
| 4450 | % @deffn def-whatever
|
|---|
| 4451 | \penalty 10001
|
|---|
| 4452 | }
|
|---|
| 4453 |
|
|---|
| 4454 |
|
|---|
| 4455 | \message{toc,}
|
|---|
| 4456 | % Table of contents.
|
|---|
| 4457 | \newwrite\tocfile
|
|---|
| 4458 |
|
|---|
| 4459 | % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
|
|---|
| 4460 | % Called from @chapter, etc.
|
|---|
| 4461 | %
|
|---|
| 4462 | % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
|
|---|
| 4463 | % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
|
|---|
| 4464 | % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
|
|---|
| 4465 | % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
|
|---|
| 4466 | % destination to jump to.
|
|---|
| 4467 | %
|
|---|
| 4468 | % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
|
|---|
| 4469 | % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
|
|---|
| 4470 | % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
|
|---|
| 4471 | % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
|
|---|
| 4472 | %
|
|---|
| 4473 | \newif\iftocfileopened
|
|---|
| 4474 | \def\omitkeyword{omit}%
|
|---|
| 4475 | %
|
|---|
| 4476 | \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
|
|---|
| 4477 | \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
|
|---|
| 4478 | \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
|
|---|
| 4479 | \iftocfileopened\else
|
|---|
| 4480 | \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
|
|---|
| 4481 | \global\tocfileopenedtrue
|
|---|
| 4482 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4483 | %
|
|---|
| 4484 | \iflinks
|
|---|
| 4485 | \toks0 = {#2}%
|
|---|
| 4486 | \toks2 = \expandafter{\lastnode}%
|
|---|
| 4487 | \edef\temp{\write\tocfile{\realbackslash #1entry{\the\toks0}{#3}%
|
|---|
| 4488 | {\the\toks2}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
|
|---|
| 4489 | \temp
|
|---|
| 4490 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4491 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4492 | %
|
|---|
| 4493 | % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
|
|---|
| 4494 | % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
|
|---|
| 4495 | % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
|
|---|
| 4496 | % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
|
|---|
| 4497 | % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
|
|---|
| 4498 | % `1', and two named `2'.
|
|---|
| 4499 | \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
|
|---|
| 4500 | }
|
|---|
| 4501 |
|
|---|
| 4502 | \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
|
|---|
| 4503 | \newcount\savepageno
|
|---|
| 4504 | \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
|
|---|
| 4505 |
|
|---|
| 4506 | % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
|
|---|
| 4507 | %
|
|---|
| 4508 | \def\startcontents#1{%
|
|---|
| 4509 | % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
|
|---|
| 4510 | % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
|
|---|
| 4511 | % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
|
|---|
| 4512 | % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
|
|---|
| 4513 | \contentsalignmacro
|
|---|
| 4514 | \immediate\closeout\tocfile
|
|---|
| 4515 | %
|
|---|
| 4516 | % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
|
|---|
| 4517 | % It is abundantly clear what they are.
|
|---|
| 4518 | \def\thischapter{}%
|
|---|
| 4519 | \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
|
|---|
| 4520 | %
|
|---|
| 4521 | \savepageno = \pageno
|
|---|
| 4522 | \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
|
|---|
| 4523 | \catcode`\\=0 \catcode`\{=1 \catcode`\}=2 \catcode`\@=11
|
|---|
| 4524 | % We can't do this, because then an actual ^ in a section
|
|---|
| 4525 | % title fails, e.g., @chapter ^ -- exponentiation. --karl, 9jul97.
|
|---|
| 4526 | %\catcode`\^=7 % to see ^^e4 as \"a etc. juha@piuha.ydi.vtt.fi
|
|---|
| 4527 | \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
|
|---|
| 4528 | \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
|
|---|
| 4529 | %
|
|---|
| 4530 | % Roman numerals for page numbers.
|
|---|
| 4531 | \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
|
|---|
| 4532 | }
|
|---|
| 4533 |
|
|---|
| 4534 |
|
|---|
| 4535 | % Normal (long) toc.
|
|---|
| 4536 | \def\contents{%
|
|---|
| 4537 | \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
|
|---|
| 4538 | \openin 1 \jobname.toc
|
|---|
| 4539 | \ifeof 1 \else
|
|---|
| 4540 | \input \jobname.toc
|
|---|
| 4541 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4542 | \vfill \eject
|
|---|
| 4543 | \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
|
|---|
| 4544 | \ifeof 1 \else
|
|---|
| 4545 | \pdfmakeoutlines
|
|---|
| 4546 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4547 | \closein 1
|
|---|
| 4548 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 4549 | \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
|
|---|
| 4550 | \global\pageno = \savepageno
|
|---|
| 4551 | }
|
|---|
| 4552 |
|
|---|
| 4553 | % And just the chapters.
|
|---|
| 4554 | \def\summarycontents{%
|
|---|
| 4555 | \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
|
|---|
| 4556 | %
|
|---|
| 4557 | \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
|
|---|
| 4558 | \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
|
|---|
| 4559 | \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
|
|---|
| 4560 | % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
|
|---|
| 4561 | \secfonts
|
|---|
| 4562 | \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
|
|---|
| 4563 | \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
|
|---|
| 4564 | \rm
|
|---|
| 4565 | \hyphenpenalty = 10000
|
|---|
| 4566 | \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
|
|---|
| 4567 | \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
|
|---|
| 4568 | \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
|
|---|
| 4569 | \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
|
|---|
| 4570 | \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
|
|---|
| 4571 | \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
|
|---|
| 4572 | \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
|
|---|
| 4573 | \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
|
|---|
| 4574 | \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
|
|---|
| 4575 | \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
|
|---|
| 4576 | \openin 1 \jobname.toc
|
|---|
| 4577 | \ifeof 1 \else
|
|---|
| 4578 | \input \jobname.toc
|
|---|
| 4579 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4580 | \closein 1
|
|---|
| 4581 | \vfill \eject
|
|---|
| 4582 | \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
|
|---|
| 4583 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 4584 | \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
|
|---|
| 4585 | \global\pageno = \savepageno
|
|---|
| 4586 | }
|
|---|
| 4587 | \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
|
|---|
| 4588 |
|
|---|
| 4589 | % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
|
|---|
| 4590 | % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
|
|---|
| 4591 | %
|
|---|
| 4592 | \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
|
|---|
| 4593 | % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
|
|---|
| 4594 | % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
|
|---|
| 4595 | % But use \hss just in case.
|
|---|
| 4596 | % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
|
|---|
| 4597 | % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
|
|---|
| 4598 | %
|
|---|
| 4599 | % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
|
|---|
| 4600 | % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
|
|---|
| 4601 | % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
|
|---|
| 4602 | % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
|
|---|
| 4603 | % there are before deciding ...
|
|---|
| 4604 | \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
|
|---|
| 4605 | }
|
|---|
| 4606 |
|
|---|
| 4607 | % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
|
|---|
| 4608 | % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
|
|---|
| 4609 | % The last argument is the page number.
|
|---|
| 4610 | % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
|
|---|
| 4611 |
|
|---|
| 4612 | % Chapters, in the main contents.
|
|---|
| 4613 | \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
|
|---|
| 4614 | %
|
|---|
| 4615 | % Chapters, in the short toc.
|
|---|
| 4616 | % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
|
|---|
| 4617 | \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
|
|---|
| 4618 | \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
|
|---|
| 4619 | }
|
|---|
| 4620 |
|
|---|
| 4621 | % Appendices, in the main contents.
|
|---|
| 4622 | % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
|
|---|
| 4623 | %
|
|---|
| 4624 | \def\appendixbox#1{%
|
|---|
| 4625 | % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
|
|---|
| 4626 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
|
|---|
| 4627 | \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
|
|---|
| 4628 | %
|
|---|
| 4629 | \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
|
|---|
| 4630 |
|
|---|
| 4631 | % Unnumbered chapters.
|
|---|
| 4632 | \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
|
|---|
| 4633 | \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
|
|---|
| 4634 |
|
|---|
| 4635 | % Sections.
|
|---|
| 4636 | \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
|
|---|
| 4637 | \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
|
|---|
| 4638 | \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
|
|---|
| 4639 |
|
|---|
| 4640 | % Subsections.
|
|---|
| 4641 | \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
|
|---|
| 4642 | \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
|
|---|
| 4643 | \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
|
|---|
| 4644 |
|
|---|
| 4645 | % And subsubsections.
|
|---|
| 4646 | \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
|
|---|
| 4647 | \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
|
|---|
| 4648 | \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
|
|---|
| 4649 |
|
|---|
| 4650 | % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
|
|---|
| 4651 | % Same as \defaultparindent.
|
|---|
| 4652 | \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
|
|---|
| 4653 |
|
|---|
| 4654 | % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
|
|---|
| 4655 | % page number.
|
|---|
| 4656 | %
|
|---|
| 4657 | % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
|
|---|
| 4658 | % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
|
|---|
| 4659 | \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
|
|---|
| 4660 | \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 4661 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 4662 | \chapentryfonts
|
|---|
| 4663 | \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
|
|---|
| 4664 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 4665 | \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
|
|---|
| 4666 | }
|
|---|
| 4667 |
|
|---|
| 4668 | \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 4669 | \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
|
|---|
| 4670 | \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
|
|---|
| 4671 | \endgroup}
|
|---|
| 4672 |
|
|---|
| 4673 | \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 4674 | \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
|
|---|
| 4675 | \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
|
|---|
| 4676 | \endgroup}
|
|---|
| 4677 |
|
|---|
| 4678 | \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 4679 | \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
|
|---|
| 4680 | \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
|
|---|
| 4681 | \endgroup}
|
|---|
| 4682 |
|
|---|
| 4683 | % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
|
|---|
| 4684 | \let\tocentry = \entry
|
|---|
| 4685 |
|
|---|
| 4686 | % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
|
|---|
| 4687 | \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
|
|---|
| 4688 |
|
|---|
| 4689 | \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
|
|---|
| 4690 | \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
|
|---|
| 4691 |
|
|---|
| 4692 | \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
|
|---|
| 4693 | \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
|
|---|
| 4694 | \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
|
|---|
| 4695 | \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
|
|---|
| 4696 |
|
|---|
| 4697 |
|
|---|
| 4698 | \message{environments,}
|
|---|
| 4699 | % @foo ... @end foo.
|
|---|
| 4700 |
|
|---|
| 4701 | % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
|
|---|
| 4702 | %
|
|---|
| 4703 | % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of
|
|---|
| 4704 | % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
|
|---|
| 4705 | %
|
|---|
| 4706 | \def\point{$\star$}
|
|---|
| 4707 | \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
|
|---|
| 4708 | \def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
|
|---|
| 4709 | \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
|
|---|
| 4710 | \def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
|
|---|
| 4711 |
|
|---|
| 4712 | % The @error{} command.
|
|---|
| 4713 | % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
|
|---|
| 4714 | %
|
|---|
| 4715 | \newbox\errorbox
|
|---|
| 4716 | %
|
|---|
| 4717 | {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
|
|---|
| 4718 | \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
|
|---|
| 4719 | % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
|
|---|
| 4720 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt}
|
|---|
| 4721 | %
|
|---|
| 4722 | \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
|
|---|
| 4723 | \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
|
|---|
| 4724 | \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
|
|---|
| 4725 | \vbox{%
|
|---|
| 4726 | \hrule height\dimen2
|
|---|
| 4727 | \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
|
|---|
| 4728 | \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
|
|---|
| 4729 | \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
|
|---|
| 4730 | \hrule height\dimen2}
|
|---|
| 4731 | \hfil}
|
|---|
| 4732 | %
|
|---|
| 4733 | \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
|
|---|
| 4734 |
|
|---|
| 4735 | % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
|
|---|
| 4736 | % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
|
|---|
| 4737 | % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
|
|---|
| 4738 |
|
|---|
| 4739 | \envdef\tex{%
|
|---|
| 4740 | \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
|
|---|
| 4741 | \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
|
|---|
| 4742 | \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
|
|---|
| 4743 | \catcode `\%=14
|
|---|
| 4744 | \catcode `\+=\other
|
|---|
| 4745 | \catcode `\"=\other
|
|---|
| 4746 | \catcode `\|=\other
|
|---|
| 4747 | \catcode `\<=\other
|
|---|
| 4748 | \catcode `\>=\other
|
|---|
| 4749 | \escapechar=`\\
|
|---|
| 4750 | %
|
|---|
| 4751 | \let\b=\ptexb
|
|---|
| 4752 | \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
|
|---|
| 4753 | \let\c=\ptexc
|
|---|
| 4754 | \let\,=\ptexcomma
|
|---|
| 4755 | \let\.=\ptexdot
|
|---|
| 4756 | \let\dots=\ptexdots
|
|---|
| 4757 | \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
|
|---|
| 4758 | \let\!=\ptexexclam
|
|---|
| 4759 | \let\i=\ptexi
|
|---|
| 4760 | \let\indent=\ptexindent
|
|---|
| 4761 | \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
|
|---|
| 4762 | \let\{=\ptexlbrace
|
|---|
| 4763 | \let\+=\tabalign
|
|---|
| 4764 | \let\}=\ptexrbrace
|
|---|
| 4765 | \let\/=\ptexslash
|
|---|
| 4766 | \let\*=\ptexstar
|
|---|
| 4767 | \let\t=\ptext
|
|---|
| 4768 | %
|
|---|
| 4769 | \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
|
|---|
| 4770 | \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
|
|---|
| 4771 | \def\@{@}%
|
|---|
| 4772 | }
|
|---|
| 4773 | % There is no need to define \Etex.
|
|---|
| 4774 |
|
|---|
| 4775 | % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
|
|---|
| 4776 | % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
|
|---|
| 4777 | % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
|
|---|
| 4778 |
|
|---|
| 4779 | % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
|
|---|
| 4780 | \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
|
|---|
| 4781 |
|
|---|
| 4782 | % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
|
|---|
| 4783 | % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
|
|---|
| 4784 | % have any width.
|
|---|
| 4785 | \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
|
|---|
| 4786 |
|
|---|
| 4787 | % This space is always present above and below environments.
|
|---|
| 4788 | \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
|
|---|
| 4789 |
|
|---|
| 4790 | % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
|
|---|
| 4791 | % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
|
|---|
| 4792 | % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
|
|---|
| 4793 | % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
|
|---|
| 4794 | %
|
|---|
| 4795 | \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
|
|---|
| 4796 | % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
|
|---|
| 4797 | % \sectionheading, q.v.
|
|---|
| 4798 | \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
|
|---|
| 4799 | \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
|
|---|
| 4800 | \endgraf
|
|---|
| 4801 | \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
|
|---|
| 4802 | \removelastskip
|
|---|
| 4803 | % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
|
|---|
| 4804 | % or better ...
|
|---|
| 4805 | \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
|
|---|
| 4806 | \vskip\envskipamount
|
|---|
| 4807 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4808 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4809 | }}
|
|---|
| 4810 |
|
|---|
| 4811 | \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
|
|---|
| 4812 |
|
|---|
| 4813 | % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins.
|
|---|
| 4814 | \let\nonarrowing=\relax
|
|---|
| 4815 |
|
|---|
| 4816 | % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
|
|---|
| 4817 | % environment contents.
|
|---|
| 4818 | \font\circle=lcircle10
|
|---|
| 4819 | \newdimen\circthick
|
|---|
| 4820 | \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
|
|---|
| 4821 | \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
|
|---|
| 4822 | \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
|
|---|
| 4823 | %
|
|---|
| 4824 | \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
|
|---|
| 4825 | \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
|
|---|
| 4826 | \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
|
|---|
| 4827 | \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
|
|---|
| 4828 | \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
|
|---|
| 4829 | \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
|
|---|
| 4830 | \hskip\rskip}}
|
|---|
| 4831 | \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
|
|---|
| 4832 | \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
|
|---|
| 4833 | \hskip\rskip}}
|
|---|
| 4834 | %
|
|---|
| 4835 | \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
|
|---|
| 4836 |
|
|---|
| 4837 | \envdef\cartouche{%
|
|---|
| 4838 | \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
|
|---|
| 4839 | \startsavinginserts
|
|---|
| 4840 | \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
|
|---|
| 4841 | \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
|
|---|
| 4842 | \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
|
|---|
| 4843 | \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
|
|---|
| 4844 | \cartouter=\hsize
|
|---|
| 4845 | \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
|
|---|
| 4846 | % side, and for 6pt waste from
|
|---|
| 4847 | % each corner char, and rule thickness
|
|---|
| 4848 | \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
|
|---|
| 4849 | % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
|
|---|
| 4850 | \let\nonarrowing=\comment
|
|---|
| 4851 | \vbox\bgroup
|
|---|
| 4852 | \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
|
|---|
| 4853 | \carttop
|
|---|
| 4854 | \hbox\bgroup
|
|---|
| 4855 | \hskip\lskip
|
|---|
| 4856 | \vrule\kern3pt
|
|---|
| 4857 | \vbox\bgroup
|
|---|
| 4858 | \kern3pt
|
|---|
| 4859 | \hsize=\cartinner
|
|---|
| 4860 | \baselineskip=\normbskip
|
|---|
| 4861 | \lineskip=\normlskip
|
|---|
| 4862 | \parskip=\normpskip
|
|---|
| 4863 | \vskip -\parskip
|
|---|
| 4864 | \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
|
|---|
| 4865 | }
|
|---|
| 4866 | \def\Ecartouche{%
|
|---|
| 4867 | \ifhmode\par\fi
|
|---|
| 4868 | \kern3pt
|
|---|
| 4869 | \egroup
|
|---|
| 4870 | \kern3pt\vrule
|
|---|
| 4871 | \hskip\rskip
|
|---|
| 4872 | \egroup
|
|---|
| 4873 | \cartbot
|
|---|
| 4874 | \egroup
|
|---|
| 4875 | \checkinserts
|
|---|
| 4876 | }
|
|---|
| 4877 |
|
|---|
| 4878 |
|
|---|
| 4879 | % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
|
|---|
| 4880 | % inside a group.
|
|---|
| 4881 | \def\nonfillstart{%
|
|---|
| 4882 | \aboveenvbreak
|
|---|
| 4883 | \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy
|
|---|
| 4884 | \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
|
|---|
| 4885 | \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
|
|---|
| 4886 | \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
|
|---|
| 4887 | \parskip = 0pt
|
|---|
| 4888 | \parindent = 0pt
|
|---|
| 4889 | \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
|
|---|
| 4890 | % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing
|
|---|
| 4891 | % at next level down.
|
|---|
| 4892 | \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
|
|---|
| 4893 | \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
|
|---|
| 4894 | \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
|
|---|
| 4895 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4896 | \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
|
|---|
| 4897 | }
|
|---|
| 4898 |
|
|---|
| 4899 | % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
|
|---|
| 4900 | % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
|
|---|
| 4901 | % This affects the following displayed environments:
|
|---|
| 4902 | % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
|
|---|
| 4903 | %
|
|---|
| 4904 | \def\smallword{small}
|
|---|
| 4905 | \def\nosmallword{nosmall}
|
|---|
| 4906 | \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
|
|---|
| 4907 | \def\setnormaldispenv{%
|
|---|
| 4908 | \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
|
|---|
| 4909 | \smallexamplefonts \rm
|
|---|
| 4910 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4911 | }
|
|---|
| 4912 | \def\setsmalldispenv{%
|
|---|
| 4913 | \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
|
|---|
| 4914 | \else
|
|---|
| 4915 | \smallexamplefonts \rm
|
|---|
| 4916 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4917 | }
|
|---|
| 4918 |
|
|---|
| 4919 | % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
|
|---|
| 4920 | % Let's do it by one command:
|
|---|
| 4921 | \def\makedispenv #1#2{
|
|---|
| 4922 | \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
|
|---|
| 4923 | \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
|
|---|
| 4924 | \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
|
|---|
| 4925 | \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
|
|---|
| 4926 | }
|
|---|
| 4927 |
|
|---|
| 4928 | % Define two synonyms:
|
|---|
| 4929 | \def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
|
|---|
| 4930 | \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
|
|---|
| 4931 | \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
|
|---|
| 4932 | }
|
|---|
| 4933 |
|
|---|
| 4934 | % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
|
|---|
| 4935 | %
|
|---|
| 4936 | % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
|
|---|
| 4937 | % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
|
|---|
| 4938 | %
|
|---|
| 4939 | \maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{%
|
|---|
| 4940 | \nonfillstart
|
|---|
| 4941 | \tt
|
|---|
| 4942 | \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
|
|---|
| 4943 | \gobble % eat return
|
|---|
| 4944 | }
|
|---|
| 4945 |
|
|---|
| 4946 | % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
|
|---|
| 4947 | %
|
|---|
| 4948 | \makedispenv {display}{%
|
|---|
| 4949 | \nonfillstart
|
|---|
| 4950 | \gobble
|
|---|
| 4951 | }
|
|---|
| 4952 |
|
|---|
| 4953 | % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
|
|---|
| 4954 | %
|
|---|
| 4955 | \makedispenv{format}{%
|
|---|
| 4956 | \let\nonarrowing = t%
|
|---|
| 4957 | \nonfillstart
|
|---|
| 4958 | \gobble
|
|---|
| 4959 | }
|
|---|
| 4960 |
|
|---|
| 4961 | % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
|
|---|
| 4962 | \envdef\flushleft{%
|
|---|
| 4963 | \let\nonarrowing = t%
|
|---|
| 4964 | \nonfillstart
|
|---|
| 4965 | \gobble
|
|---|
| 4966 | }
|
|---|
| 4967 | \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
|
|---|
| 4968 |
|
|---|
| 4969 | % @flushright.
|
|---|
| 4970 | %
|
|---|
| 4971 | \envdef\flushright{%
|
|---|
| 4972 | \let\nonarrowing = t%
|
|---|
| 4973 | \nonfillstart
|
|---|
| 4974 | \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill
|
|---|
| 4975 | \gobble
|
|---|
| 4976 | }
|
|---|
| 4977 | \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
|
|---|
| 4978 |
|
|---|
| 4979 |
|
|---|
| 4980 | % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
|
|---|
| 4981 | % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
|
|---|
| 4982 | % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
|
|---|
| 4983 | % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
|
|---|
| 4984 | %
|
|---|
| 4985 | \envdef\quotation{%
|
|---|
| 4986 | {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
|
|---|
| 4987 | \parindent=0pt
|
|---|
| 4988 | %
|
|---|
| 4989 | % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
|
|---|
| 4990 | \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
|
|---|
| 4991 | \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
|
|---|
| 4992 | \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
|
|---|
| 4993 | \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
|
|---|
| 4994 | \let\nonarrowing = \relax
|
|---|
| 4995 | \fi
|
|---|
| 4996 | \parsearg\quotationlabel
|
|---|
| 4997 | }
|
|---|
| 4998 |
|
|---|
| 4999 | % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
|
|---|
| 5000 | % doing normal filling.
|
|---|
| 5001 | %
|
|---|
| 5002 | \def\Equotation{%
|
|---|
| 5003 | \par
|
|---|
| 5004 | \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
|
|---|
| 5005 | % indent a bit.
|
|---|
| 5006 | \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
|
|---|
| 5007 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5008 | {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
|
|---|
| 5009 | }
|
|---|
| 5010 |
|
|---|
| 5011 | % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
|
|---|
| 5012 | \def\quotationlabel#1{%
|
|---|
| 5013 | \def\temp{#1}%
|
|---|
| 5014 | \ifx\temp\empty \else
|
|---|
| 5015 | {\bf #1: }%
|
|---|
| 5016 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5017 | }
|
|---|
| 5018 |
|
|---|
| 5019 |
|
|---|
| 5020 | % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
|
|---|
| 5021 | % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
|
|---|
| 5022 | % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
|
|---|
| 5023 | % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
|
|---|
| 5024 | %
|
|---|
| 5025 | % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
|
|---|
| 5026 | %
|
|---|
| 5027 | % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
|
|---|
| 5028 | % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
|
|---|
| 5029 | % verbatim line.
|
|---|
| 5030 | \def\dospecials{%
|
|---|
| 5031 | \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
|
|---|
| 5032 | \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
|
|---|
| 5033 | \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
|
|---|
| 5034 | }
|
|---|
| 5035 | %
|
|---|
| 5036 | % [Knuth] p. 380
|
|---|
| 5037 | \def\uncatcodespecials{%
|
|---|
| 5038 | \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
|
|---|
| 5039 | %
|
|---|
| 5040 | % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
|
|---|
| 5041 | % Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font
|
|---|
| 5042 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 5043 | \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq}
|
|---|
| 5044 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 5045 | %
|
|---|
| 5046 | % Setup for the @verb command.
|
|---|
| 5047 | %
|
|---|
| 5048 | % Eight spaces for a tab
|
|---|
| 5049 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 5050 | \catcode`\^^I=\active
|
|---|
| 5051 | \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
|
|---|
| 5052 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 5053 | %
|
|---|
| 5054 | \def\setupverb{%
|
|---|
| 5055 | \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
|
|---|
| 5056 | \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
|
|---|
| 5057 | \catcode`\`=\active
|
|---|
| 5058 | \tabeightspaces
|
|---|
| 5059 | % Respect line breaks,
|
|---|
| 5060 | % print special symbols as themselves, and
|
|---|
| 5061 | % make each space count
|
|---|
| 5062 | % must do in this order:
|
|---|
| 5063 | \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
|
|---|
| 5064 | }
|
|---|
| 5065 |
|
|---|
| 5066 | % Setup for the @verbatim environment
|
|---|
| 5067 | %
|
|---|
| 5068 | % Real tab expansion
|
|---|
| 5069 | \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
|
|---|
| 5070 | %
|
|---|
| 5071 | \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup}
|
|---|
| 5072 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 5073 | \catcode`\^^I=\active
|
|---|
| 5074 | \gdef\tabexpand{%
|
|---|
| 5075 | \catcode`\^^I=\active
|
|---|
| 5076 | \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
|
|---|
| 5077 | \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab
|
|---|
| 5078 | \divide\dimen0 by\tabw
|
|---|
| 5079 | \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
|
|---|
| 5080 | \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
|
|---|
| 5081 | \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
|
|---|
| 5082 | }%
|
|---|
| 5083 | }
|
|---|
| 5084 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 5085 | \def\setupverbatim{%
|
|---|
| 5086 | \nonfillstart
|
|---|
| 5087 | \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
|
|---|
| 5088 | % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
|
|---|
| 5089 | \tt
|
|---|
| 5090 | \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
|
|---|
| 5091 | \catcode`\`=\active
|
|---|
| 5092 | \tabexpand
|
|---|
| 5093 | % Respect line breaks,
|
|---|
| 5094 | % print special symbols as themselves, and
|
|---|
| 5095 | % make each space count
|
|---|
| 5096 | % must do in this order:
|
|---|
| 5097 | \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
|
|---|
| 5098 | \everypar{\starttabbox}%
|
|---|
| 5099 | }
|
|---|
| 5100 |
|
|---|
| 5101 | % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
|
|---|
| 5102 | % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
|
|---|
| 5103 | % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
|
|---|
| 5104 | %
|
|---|
| 5105 | % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
|
|---|
| 5106 | %
|
|---|
| 5107 | % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
|
|---|
| 5108 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 5109 | \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
|
|---|
| 5110 | \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
|
|---|
| 5111 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 5112 | %
|
|---|
| 5113 | \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
|
|---|
| 5114 | %
|
|---|
| 5115 | %
|
|---|
| 5116 | % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
|
|---|
| 5117 | % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
|
|---|
| 5118 | %
|
|---|
| 5119 | % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
|
|---|
| 5120 | %
|
|---|
| 5121 | % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
|
|---|
| 5122 | % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
|
|---|
| 5123 | % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
|
|---|
| 5124 | %
|
|---|
| 5125 | % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
|
|---|
| 5126 | %
|
|---|
| 5127 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 5128 | \catcode`\ =\active
|
|---|
| 5129 | \obeylines %
|
|---|
| 5130 | % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
|
|---|
| 5131 | % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
|
|---|
| 5132 | % line in the output.
|
|---|
| 5133 | \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
|
|---|
| 5134 | % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
|
|---|
| 5135 | % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
|
|---|
| 5136 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 5137 | %
|
|---|
| 5138 | \envdef\verbatim{%
|
|---|
| 5139 | \setupverbatim\doverbatim
|
|---|
| 5140 | }
|
|---|
| 5141 | \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
|
|---|
| 5142 |
|
|---|
| 5143 |
|
|---|
| 5144 | % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
|
|---|
| 5145 | %
|
|---|
| 5146 | \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
|
|---|
| 5147 | %
|
|---|
| 5148 | \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
|
|---|
| 5149 | {%
|
|---|
| 5150 | \makevalueexpandable
|
|---|
| 5151 | \setupverbatim
|
|---|
| 5152 | \input #1
|
|---|
| 5153 | \afterenvbreak
|
|---|
| 5154 | }%
|
|---|
| 5155 | }
|
|---|
| 5156 |
|
|---|
| 5157 | % @copying ... @end copying.
|
|---|
| 5158 | % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
|
|---|
| 5159 | %
|
|---|
| 5160 | % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
|
|---|
| 5161 | % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
|
|---|
| 5162 | % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
|
|---|
| 5163 | % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
|
|---|
| 5164 | % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
|
|---|
| 5165 | % possible is very desirable.
|
|---|
| 5166 | %
|
|---|
| 5167 | \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
|
|---|
| 5168 | \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
|
|---|
| 5169 | %
|
|---|
| 5170 | \def\insertcopying{%
|
|---|
| 5171 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 5172 | \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
|
|---|
| 5173 | \scanexp\copyingtext
|
|---|
| 5174 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 5175 | }
|
|---|
| 5176 |
|
|---|
| 5177 | \message{defuns,}
|
|---|
| 5178 | % @defun etc.
|
|---|
| 5179 |
|
|---|
| 5180 | \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
|
|---|
| 5181 | \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
|
|---|
| 5182 | \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
|
|---|
| 5183 |
|
|---|
| 5184 | % Start the processing of @deffn:
|
|---|
| 5185 | \def\startdefun{%
|
|---|
| 5186 | \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
|
|---|
| 5187 | \medbreak
|
|---|
| 5188 | \else
|
|---|
| 5189 | % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
|
|---|
| 5190 | % which is there to keep the function description together with its
|
|---|
| 5191 | % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
|
|---|
| 5192 | % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
|
|---|
| 5193 | % by \defargscommonending, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
|
|---|
| 5194 | % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
|
|---|
| 5195 | % a break between a section heading and a defun.
|
|---|
| 5196 | %
|
|---|
| 5197 | \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \fi
|
|---|
| 5198 | %
|
|---|
| 5199 | % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
|
|---|
| 5200 | % But do insert the glue.
|
|---|
| 5201 | \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
|
|---|
| 5202 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5203 | %
|
|---|
| 5204 | \parindent=0in
|
|---|
| 5205 | \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
|
|---|
| 5206 | \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
|
|---|
| 5207 | }
|
|---|
| 5208 |
|
|---|
| 5209 | \def\dodefunx#1{%
|
|---|
| 5210 | % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
|
|---|
| 5211 | \checkenv#1%
|
|---|
| 5212 | %
|
|---|
| 5213 | % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
|
|---|
| 5214 | % It's not a great place, though.
|
|---|
| 5215 | \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \fi
|
|---|
| 5216 | %
|
|---|
| 5217 | % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
|
|---|
| 5218 | \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
|
|---|
| 5219 | }
|
|---|
| 5220 | \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
|
|---|
| 5221 |
|
|---|
| 5222 | % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
|
|---|
| 5223 | %
|
|---|
| 5224 | \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
|
|---|
| 5225 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 5226 | % call \deffnheader:
|
|---|
| 5227 | #1#2 \endheader
|
|---|
| 5228 | % common ending:
|
|---|
| 5229 | \interlinepenalty = 10000
|
|---|
| 5230 | \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
|
|---|
| 5231 | \endgraf
|
|---|
| 5232 | \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
|
|---|
| 5233 | \penalty 10002 % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
|
|---|
| 5234 | % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
|
|---|
| 5235 | % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
|
|---|
| 5236 | \checkparencounts
|
|---|
| 5237 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 5238 | }
|
|---|
| 5239 |
|
|---|
| 5240 | \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
|
|---|
| 5241 |
|
|---|
| 5242 | % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
|
|---|
| 5243 | % the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader.
|
|---|
| 5244 | %
|
|---|
| 5245 | \def\makedefun#1{%
|
|---|
| 5246 | \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
|
|---|
| 5247 | \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
|
|---|
| 5248 | \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
|
|---|
| 5249 | \temp
|
|---|
| 5250 | }
|
|---|
| 5251 |
|
|---|
| 5252 | % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
|
|---|
| 5253 | %
|
|---|
| 5254 | % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
|
|---|
| 5255 | % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
|
|---|
| 5256 | %
|
|---|
| 5257 | \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
|
|---|
| 5258 | \envdef#1{%
|
|---|
| 5259 | \startdefun
|
|---|
| 5260 | \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
|
|---|
| 5261 | }%
|
|---|
| 5262 | \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
|
|---|
| 5263 | \def#3%
|
|---|
| 5264 | }
|
|---|
| 5265 |
|
|---|
| 5266 | %%% Untyped functions:
|
|---|
| 5267 |
|
|---|
| 5268 | % @deffn category name args
|
|---|
| 5269 | \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
|
|---|
| 5270 |
|
|---|
| 5271 | % @deffn category class name args
|
|---|
| 5272 | \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
|
|---|
| 5273 |
|
|---|
| 5274 | % \defopon {category on}class name args
|
|---|
| 5275 | \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
|
|---|
| 5276 |
|
|---|
| 5277 | % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
|
|---|
| 5278 | %
|
|---|
| 5279 | \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
|
|---|
| 5280 | % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
|
|---|
| 5281 | \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
|
|---|
| 5282 | \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
|
|---|
| 5283 | }
|
|---|
| 5284 |
|
|---|
| 5285 | %%% Typed functions:
|
|---|
| 5286 |
|
|---|
| 5287 | % @deftypefn category type name args
|
|---|
| 5288 | \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
|
|---|
| 5289 |
|
|---|
| 5290 | % @deftypeop category class type name args
|
|---|
| 5291 | \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
|
|---|
| 5292 |
|
|---|
| 5293 | % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
|
|---|
| 5294 | \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
|
|---|
| 5295 |
|
|---|
| 5296 | % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
|
|---|
| 5297 | %
|
|---|
| 5298 | \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
|
|---|
| 5299 | \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
|
|---|
| 5300 | \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
|
|---|
| 5301 | }
|
|---|
| 5302 |
|
|---|
| 5303 | %%% Typed variables:
|
|---|
| 5304 |
|
|---|
| 5305 | % @deftypevr category type var args
|
|---|
| 5306 | \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
|
|---|
| 5307 |
|
|---|
| 5308 | % @deftypecv category class type var args
|
|---|
| 5309 | \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
|
|---|
| 5310 |
|
|---|
| 5311 | % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
|
|---|
| 5312 | \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
|
|---|
| 5313 |
|
|---|
| 5314 | % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
|
|---|
| 5315 | %
|
|---|
| 5316 | \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
|
|---|
| 5317 | \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
|
|---|
| 5318 | \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
|
|---|
| 5319 | }
|
|---|
| 5320 |
|
|---|
| 5321 | %%% Untyped variables:
|
|---|
| 5322 |
|
|---|
| 5323 | % @defvr category var args
|
|---|
| 5324 | \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
|
|---|
| 5325 |
|
|---|
| 5326 | % @defcv category class var args
|
|---|
| 5327 | \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
|
|---|
| 5328 |
|
|---|
| 5329 | % \defcvof {category of}class var args
|
|---|
| 5330 | \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
|
|---|
| 5331 |
|
|---|
| 5332 | %%% Type:
|
|---|
| 5333 | % @deftp category name args
|
|---|
| 5334 | \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
|
|---|
| 5335 | \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
|
|---|
| 5336 | \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
|
|---|
| 5337 | }
|
|---|
| 5338 |
|
|---|
| 5339 | % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
|
|---|
| 5340 | \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
|
|---|
| 5341 | \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
|
|---|
| 5342 | \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
|
|---|
| 5343 | \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
|
|---|
| 5344 | \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
|
|---|
| 5345 | \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
|
|---|
| 5346 | \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
|
|---|
| 5347 | \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
|
|---|
| 5348 | \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
|
|---|
| 5349 | \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
|
|---|
| 5350 | \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
|
|---|
| 5351 |
|
|---|
| 5352 | % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
|
|---|
| 5353 | % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
|
|---|
| 5354 | % #2 is the return type, if any.
|
|---|
| 5355 | % #3 is the function name.
|
|---|
| 5356 | %
|
|---|
| 5357 | % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
|
|---|
| 5358 | %
|
|---|
| 5359 | \def\defname#1#2#3{%
|
|---|
| 5360 | % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
|
|---|
| 5361 | \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
|
|---|
| 5362 | %
|
|---|
| 5363 | % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps
|
|---|
| 5364 | % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
|
|---|
| 5365 | % just below it.
|
|---|
| 5366 | \def\temp{#1}%
|
|---|
| 5367 | \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
|
|---|
| 5368 | %
|
|---|
| 5369 | % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
|
|---|
| 5370 | % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
|
|---|
| 5371 | % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
|
|---|
| 5372 | \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
|
|---|
| 5373 | % The continuations:
|
|---|
| 5374 | \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
|
|---|
| 5375 | % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
|
|---|
| 5376 | \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
|
|---|
| 5377 | %
|
|---|
| 5378 | % Put the type name to the right margin.
|
|---|
| 5379 | \noindent
|
|---|
| 5380 | \hbox to 0pt{%
|
|---|
| 5381 | \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
|
|---|
| 5382 | % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
|
|---|
| 5383 | \kern\leftskip
|
|---|
| 5384 | % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
|
|---|
| 5385 | }%
|
|---|
| 5386 | %
|
|---|
| 5387 | % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
|
|---|
| 5388 | \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
|
|---|
| 5389 | \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
|
|---|
| 5390 | {%
|
|---|
| 5391 | % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
|
|---|
| 5392 | % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
|
|---|
| 5393 | % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
|
|---|
| 5394 | % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
|
|---|
| 5395 | % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
|
|---|
| 5396 | % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
|
|---|
| 5397 | % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
|
|---|
| 5398 | % one has made identifiers using them :).
|
|---|
| 5399 | \df \tt
|
|---|
| 5400 | \def\temp{#2}% return value type
|
|---|
| 5401 | \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
|
|---|
| 5402 | #3% output function name
|
|---|
| 5403 | }%
|
|---|
| 5404 | {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
|
|---|
| 5405 | %
|
|---|
| 5406 | \boldbrax
|
|---|
| 5407 | % arguments will be output next, if any.
|
|---|
| 5408 | }
|
|---|
| 5409 |
|
|---|
| 5410 | % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
|
|---|
| 5411 | % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
|
|---|
| 5412 | % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
|
|---|
| 5413 | % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
|
|---|
| 5414 | %
|
|---|
| 5415 | \def\defunargs#1{%
|
|---|
| 5416 | % use sl by default (not ttsl),
|
|---|
| 5417 | % tt for the names.
|
|---|
| 5418 | \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
|
|---|
| 5419 | %
|
|---|
| 5420 | % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
|
|---|
| 5421 | % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
|
|---|
| 5422 | \let\var=\ttslanted
|
|---|
| 5423 | #1%
|
|---|
| 5424 | \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
|
|---|
| 5425 | }
|
|---|
| 5426 |
|
|---|
| 5427 | % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
|
|---|
| 5428 | %
|
|---|
| 5429 | \def\activeparens{%
|
|---|
| 5430 | \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
|
|---|
| 5431 | \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
|
|---|
| 5432 | \catcode`\&=\active
|
|---|
| 5433 | }
|
|---|
| 5434 |
|
|---|
| 5435 | % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
|
|---|
| 5436 | \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
|
|---|
| 5437 |
|
|---|
| 5438 | % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
|
|---|
| 5439 | % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
|
|---|
| 5440 | % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
|
|---|
| 5441 | {
|
|---|
| 5442 | \activeparens
|
|---|
| 5443 | \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
|
|---|
| 5444 | \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
|
|---|
| 5445 | \global\let& = \&
|
|---|
| 5446 |
|
|---|
| 5447 | \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
|
|---|
| 5448 | \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
|
|---|
| 5449 | }
|
|---|
| 5450 |
|
|---|
| 5451 | \newcount\parencount
|
|---|
| 5452 |
|
|---|
| 5453 | % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
|
|---|
| 5454 | \newif\ifampseen
|
|---|
| 5455 | \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\ }}
|
|---|
| 5456 |
|
|---|
| 5457 | \def\parenfont{%
|
|---|
| 5458 | \ifampseen
|
|---|
| 5459 | % At the first level, print parens in roman,
|
|---|
| 5460 | % otherwise use the default font.
|
|---|
| 5461 | \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
|
|---|
| 5462 | \else
|
|---|
| 5463 | % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
|
|---|
| 5464 | % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
|
|---|
| 5465 | \sf
|
|---|
| 5466 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5467 | }
|
|---|
| 5468 | \def\infirstlevel#1{%
|
|---|
| 5469 | \ifampseen
|
|---|
| 5470 | \ifnum\parencount=1
|
|---|
| 5471 | #1%
|
|---|
| 5472 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5473 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5474 | }
|
|---|
| 5475 | \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
|
|---|
| 5476 |
|
|---|
| 5477 | \def\opnr{%
|
|---|
| 5478 | \global\advance\parencount by 1
|
|---|
| 5479 | {\parenfont(}%
|
|---|
| 5480 | \infirstlevel \bfafterword
|
|---|
| 5481 | }
|
|---|
| 5482 | \def\clnr{%
|
|---|
| 5483 | {\parenfont)}%
|
|---|
| 5484 | \infirstlevel \sl
|
|---|
| 5485 | \global\advance\parencount by -1
|
|---|
| 5486 | }
|
|---|
| 5487 |
|
|---|
| 5488 | \newcount\brackcount
|
|---|
| 5489 | \def\lbrb{%
|
|---|
| 5490 | \global\advance\brackcount by 1
|
|---|
| 5491 | {\bf[}%
|
|---|
| 5492 | }
|
|---|
| 5493 | \def\rbrb{%
|
|---|
| 5494 | {\bf]}%
|
|---|
| 5495 | \global\advance\brackcount by -1
|
|---|
| 5496 | }
|
|---|
| 5497 |
|
|---|
| 5498 | \def\checkparencounts{%
|
|---|
| 5499 | \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
|
|---|
| 5500 | \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
|
|---|
| 5501 | }
|
|---|
| 5502 | \def\badparencount{%
|
|---|
| 5503 | \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}%
|
|---|
| 5504 | \global\parencount=0
|
|---|
| 5505 | }
|
|---|
| 5506 | \def\badbrackcount{%
|
|---|
| 5507 | \errmessage{Unbalanced square braces in @def}%
|
|---|
| 5508 | \global\brackcount=0
|
|---|
| 5509 | }
|
|---|
| 5510 |
|
|---|
| 5511 |
|
|---|
| 5512 | \message{macros,}
|
|---|
| 5513 | % @macro.
|
|---|
| 5514 |
|
|---|
| 5515 | % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
|
|---|
| 5516 | % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
|
|---|
| 5517 | \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
|
|---|
| 5518 | \newwrite\macscribble
|
|---|
| 5519 | \def\scantokens#1{%
|
|---|
| 5520 | \toks0={#1}%
|
|---|
| 5521 | \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
|
|---|
| 5522 | \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
|
|---|
| 5523 | \immediate\closeout\macscribble
|
|---|
| 5524 | \input \jobname.tmp
|
|---|
| 5525 | }
|
|---|
| 5526 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5527 |
|
|---|
| 5528 | \def\scanmacro#1{%
|
|---|
| 5529 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 5530 | \newlinechar`\^^M
|
|---|
| 5531 | \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
|
|---|
| 5532 | % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
|
|---|
| 5533 | % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
|
|---|
| 5534 | % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
|
|---|
| 5535 | % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
|
|---|
| 5536 | % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
|
|---|
| 5537 | \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
|
|---|
| 5538 | % ... and \example
|
|---|
| 5539 | \spaceisspace
|
|---|
| 5540 | %
|
|---|
| 5541 | % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
|
|---|
| 5542 | %
|
|---|
| 5543 | % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
|
|---|
| 5544 | % --kasal, 29nov03
|
|---|
| 5545 | \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
|
|---|
| 5546 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 5547 | }
|
|---|
| 5548 |
|
|---|
| 5549 | \def\scanexp#1{%
|
|---|
| 5550 | \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
|
|---|
| 5551 | \temp
|
|---|
| 5552 | }
|
|---|
| 5553 |
|
|---|
| 5554 | \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
|
|---|
| 5555 | \newtoks\macname % Macro name
|
|---|
| 5556 | \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
|
|---|
| 5557 | \def\macrolist{} % List of all defined macros in the form
|
|---|
| 5558 | % \do\macro1\do\macro2...
|
|---|
| 5559 |
|
|---|
| 5560 | % Utility routines.
|
|---|
| 5561 | % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
|
|---|
| 5562 | % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
|
|---|
| 5563 | % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
|
|---|
| 5564 | %
|
|---|
| 5565 | \def\cslet#1#2{%
|
|---|
| 5566 | \expandafter\let
|
|---|
| 5567 | \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
|
|---|
| 5568 | \csname#2\endcsname
|
|---|
| 5569 | }
|
|---|
| 5570 |
|
|---|
| 5571 | % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
|
|---|
| 5572 | % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
|
|---|
| 5573 | {\catcode`\@=11
|
|---|
| 5574 | \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
|
|---|
| 5575 | \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
|
|---|
| 5576 | \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
|
|---|
| 5577 | \def\unbrace#1{#1}
|
|---|
| 5578 | \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
|
|---|
| 5579 | }
|
|---|
| 5580 |
|
|---|
| 5581 | % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
|
|---|
| 5582 | {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
|
|---|
| 5583 | \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
|
|---|
| 5584 | \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
|
|---|
| 5585 | \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
|
|---|
| 5586 | }
|
|---|
| 5587 |
|
|---|
| 5588 | % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
|
|---|
| 5589 | % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
|
|---|
| 5590 | % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
|
|---|
| 5591 |
|
|---|
| 5592 | % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
|
|---|
| 5593 | % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
|
|---|
| 5594 | % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
|
|---|
| 5595 |
|
|---|
| 5596 | \def\scanctxt{%
|
|---|
| 5597 | \catcode`\"=\other
|
|---|
| 5598 | \catcode`\+=\other
|
|---|
| 5599 | \catcode`\<=\other
|
|---|
| 5600 | \catcode`\>=\other
|
|---|
| 5601 | \catcode`\@=\other
|
|---|
| 5602 | \catcode`\^=\other
|
|---|
| 5603 | \catcode`\_=\other
|
|---|
| 5604 | \catcode`\|=\other
|
|---|
| 5605 | \catcode`\~=\other
|
|---|
| 5606 | }
|
|---|
| 5607 |
|
|---|
| 5608 | \def\scanargctxt{%
|
|---|
| 5609 | \scanctxt
|
|---|
| 5610 | \catcode`\\=\other
|
|---|
| 5611 | \catcode`\^^M=\other
|
|---|
| 5612 | }
|
|---|
| 5613 |
|
|---|
| 5614 | \def\macrobodyctxt{%
|
|---|
| 5615 | \scanctxt
|
|---|
| 5616 | \catcode`\{=\other
|
|---|
| 5617 | \catcode`\}=\other
|
|---|
| 5618 | \catcode`\^^M=\other
|
|---|
| 5619 | \usembodybackslash
|
|---|
| 5620 | }
|
|---|
| 5621 |
|
|---|
| 5622 | \def\macroargctxt{%
|
|---|
| 5623 | \scanctxt
|
|---|
| 5624 | \catcode`\\=\other
|
|---|
| 5625 | }
|
|---|
| 5626 |
|
|---|
| 5627 | % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
|
|---|
| 5628 | % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
|
|---|
| 5629 | % where N is the macro parameter number.
|
|---|
| 5630 | % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
|
|---|
| 5631 | % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
|
|---|
| 5632 |
|
|---|
| 5633 | {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
|
|---|
| 5634 | @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
|
|---|
| 5635 | @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
|
|---|
| 5636 | }
|
|---|
| 5637 | \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
|
|---|
| 5638 |
|
|---|
| 5639 | \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
|
|---|
| 5640 | \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
|
|---|
| 5641 |
|
|---|
| 5642 | \def\macroxxx#1{%
|
|---|
| 5643 | \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
|
|---|
| 5644 | \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
|
|---|
| 5645 | \paramno=0%
|
|---|
| 5646 | \else
|
|---|
| 5647 | \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
|
|---|
| 5648 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5649 | \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
|
|---|
| 5650 | \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
|
|---|
| 5651 | \else
|
|---|
| 5652 | \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
|
|---|
| 5653 | \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
|
|---|
| 5654 | \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
|
|---|
| 5655 | \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
|
|---|
| 5656 | % Add the macroname to \macrolist
|
|---|
| 5657 | \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\do}%
|
|---|
| 5658 | \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0
|
|---|
| 5659 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname\endcsname}%
|
|---|
| 5660 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5661 | \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
|
|---|
| 5662 | \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
|
|---|
| 5663 | \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
|
|---|
| 5664 | \fi}
|
|---|
| 5665 |
|
|---|
| 5666 | \parseargdef\unmacro{%
|
|---|
| 5667 | \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
|
|---|
| 5668 | \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
|
|---|
| 5669 | \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
|
|---|
| 5670 | % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
|
|---|
| 5671 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 5672 | \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
|
|---|
| 5673 | \let\do\unmacrodo
|
|---|
| 5674 | \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
|
|---|
| 5675 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 5676 | \else
|
|---|
| 5677 | \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
|
|---|
| 5678 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5679 | }
|
|---|
| 5680 |
|
|---|
| 5681 | % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
|
|---|
| 5682 | % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
|
|---|
| 5683 | %
|
|---|
| 5684 | \def\unmacrodo#1{%
|
|---|
| 5685 | \ifx#1\relax
|
|---|
| 5686 | % remove this
|
|---|
| 5687 | \else
|
|---|
| 5688 | \noexpand\do \noexpand #1%
|
|---|
| 5689 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5690 | }
|
|---|
| 5691 |
|
|---|
| 5692 | % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
|
|---|
| 5693 | % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
|
|---|
| 5694 | % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
|
|---|
| 5695 | \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
|
|---|
| 5696 | \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
|
|---|
| 5697 | \def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
|
|---|
| 5698 | \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
|
|---|
| 5699 |
|
|---|
| 5700 | % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
|
|---|
| 5701 | % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah
|
|---|
| 5702 | % in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list.
|
|---|
| 5703 | % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
|
|---|
| 5704 |
|
|---|
| 5705 | % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
|
|---|
| 5706 | % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
|
|---|
| 5707 | % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
|
|---|
| 5708 | % it to # just before using the token list produced.
|
|---|
| 5709 | %
|
|---|
| 5710 | % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
|
|---|
| 5711 | % the macro is used.
|
|---|
| 5712 |
|
|---|
| 5713 | \def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
|
|---|
| 5714 | \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,}
|
|---|
| 5715 | \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
|
|---|
| 5716 | \if#1;\let\next=\relax
|
|---|
| 5717 | \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
|
|---|
| 5718 | \advance\paramno by 1%
|
|---|
| 5719 | \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
|
|---|
| 5720 | {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
|
|---|
| 5721 | \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
|
|---|
| 5722 | \fi\next}
|
|---|
| 5723 |
|
|---|
| 5724 | % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
|
|---|
| 5725 | % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
|
|---|
| 5726 |
|
|---|
| 5727 | \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro%
|
|---|
| 5728 | {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
|
|---|
| 5729 | \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro%
|
|---|
| 5730 | {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
|
|---|
| 5731 |
|
|---|
| 5732 | % This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and
|
|---|
| 5733 | % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments.
|
|---|
| 5734 | % Much magic with \expandafter here.
|
|---|
| 5735 | % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
|
|---|
| 5736 | % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
|
|---|
| 5737 | \def\defmacro{%
|
|---|
| 5738 | \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
|
|---|
| 5739 | \ifrecursive
|
|---|
| 5740 | \ifcase\paramno
|
|---|
| 5741 | % 0
|
|---|
| 5742 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
|
|---|
| 5743 | \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
|
|---|
| 5744 | \or % 1
|
|---|
| 5745 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
|
|---|
| 5746 | \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
|
|---|
| 5747 | \noexpand\braceorline
|
|---|
| 5748 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
|
|---|
| 5749 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
|
|---|
| 5750 | \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
|
|---|
| 5751 | \else % many
|
|---|
| 5752 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
|
|---|
| 5753 | \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
|
|---|
| 5754 | \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
|
|---|
| 5755 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
|
|---|
| 5756 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
|
|---|
| 5757 | \expandafter\expandafter
|
|---|
| 5758 | \expandafter\xdef
|
|---|
| 5759 | \expandafter\expandafter
|
|---|
| 5760 | \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
|
|---|
| 5761 | \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
|
|---|
| 5762 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5763 | \else
|
|---|
| 5764 | \ifcase\paramno
|
|---|
| 5765 | % 0
|
|---|
| 5766 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
|
|---|
| 5767 | \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
|
|---|
| 5768 | \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
|
|---|
| 5769 | \or % 1
|
|---|
| 5770 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
|
|---|
| 5771 | \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
|
|---|
| 5772 | \noexpand\braceorline
|
|---|
| 5773 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
|
|---|
| 5774 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
|
|---|
| 5775 | \egroup
|
|---|
| 5776 | \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
|
|---|
| 5777 | \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
|
|---|
| 5778 | \else % many
|
|---|
| 5779 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
|
|---|
| 5780 | \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
|
|---|
| 5781 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
|
|---|
| 5782 | \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
|
|---|
| 5783 | \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
|
|---|
| 5784 | \expandafter\expandafter
|
|---|
| 5785 | \expandafter\xdef
|
|---|
| 5786 | \expandafter\expandafter
|
|---|
| 5787 | \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
|
|---|
| 5788 | \paramlist{%
|
|---|
| 5789 | \egroup
|
|---|
| 5790 | \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
|
|---|
| 5791 | \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
|
|---|
| 5792 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5793 | \fi}
|
|---|
| 5794 |
|
|---|
| 5795 | \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
|
|---|
| 5796 |
|
|---|
| 5797 | % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
|
|---|
| 5798 | % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
|
|---|
| 5799 | % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
|
|---|
| 5800 | % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
|
|---|
| 5801 | \def\braceorline#1{\let\next=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
|
|---|
| 5802 | \def\braceorlinexxx{%
|
|---|
| 5803 | \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
|
|---|
| 5804 | \expandafter\parsearg
|
|---|
| 5805 | \fi \next}
|
|---|
| 5806 |
|
|---|
| 5807 | % We want to disable all macros during \shipout so that they are not
|
|---|
| 5808 | % expanded by \write.
|
|---|
| 5809 | \def\turnoffmacros{\begingroup \def\do##1{\let\noexpand##1=\relax}%
|
|---|
| 5810 | \edef\next{\macrolist}\expandafter\endgroup\next}
|
|---|
| 5811 |
|
|---|
| 5812 | % For \indexnofonts, we need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the
|
|---|
| 5813 | % arguments (if present). Of course this is not nearly correct, but it
|
|---|
| 5814 | % is the best we can do for now. makeinfo does not expand macros in the
|
|---|
| 5815 | % argument to @deffn, which ends up writing an index entry, and texindex
|
|---|
| 5816 | % isn't prepared for an index sort entry that starts with \.
|
|---|
| 5817 | %
|
|---|
| 5818 | % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
|
|---|
| 5819 | % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
|
|---|
| 5820 | % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
|
|---|
| 5821 | %
|
|---|
| 5822 | \def\emptyusermacros{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 5823 | \def\do##1{\let\noexpand##1=\noexpand\asis}%
|
|---|
| 5824 | \edef\next{\macrolist}\expandafter\endgroup\next}
|
|---|
| 5825 |
|
|---|
| 5826 |
|
|---|
| 5827 | % @alias.
|
|---|
| 5828 | % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
|
|---|
| 5829 | % sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
|
|---|
| 5830 | \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
|
|---|
| 5831 | \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
|
|---|
| 5832 | \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
|
|---|
| 5833 | {%
|
|---|
| 5834 | \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
|
|---|
| 5835 | \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
|
|---|
| 5836 | }%
|
|---|
| 5837 | \next
|
|---|
| 5838 | }
|
|---|
| 5839 |
|
|---|
| 5840 |
|
|---|
| 5841 | \message{cross references,}
|
|---|
| 5842 |
|
|---|
| 5843 | \newwrite\auxfile
|
|---|
| 5844 |
|
|---|
| 5845 | \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
|
|---|
| 5846 | \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
|
|---|
| 5847 |
|
|---|
| 5848 | % @inforef is relatively simple.
|
|---|
| 5849 | \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
|
|---|
| 5850 | \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
|
|---|
| 5851 | node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
|
|---|
| 5852 |
|
|---|
| 5853 | % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
|
|---|
| 5854 | % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
|
|---|
| 5855 | % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
|
|---|
| 5856 | % @node foo , bar , ...
|
|---|
| 5857 | % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
|
|---|
| 5858 | %
|
|---|
| 5859 | \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
|
|---|
| 5860 | %
|
|---|
| 5861 | % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
|
|---|
| 5862 | % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
|
|---|
| 5863 | \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
|
|---|
| 5864 | \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
|
|---|
| 5865 |
|
|---|
| 5866 | \let\nwnode=\node
|
|---|
| 5867 | \let\lastnode=\empty
|
|---|
| 5868 |
|
|---|
| 5869 | % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
|
|---|
| 5870 | % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
|
|---|
| 5871 | %
|
|---|
| 5872 | \def\donoderef#1{%
|
|---|
| 5873 | \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
|
|---|
| 5874 | \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
|
|---|
| 5875 | \global\let\lastnode=\empty
|
|---|
| 5876 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5877 | }
|
|---|
| 5878 |
|
|---|
| 5879 | % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
|
|---|
| 5880 | %
|
|---|
| 5881 | \newcount\savesfregister
|
|---|
| 5882 | %
|
|---|
| 5883 | \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
|
|---|
| 5884 | \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
|
|---|
| 5885 | \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
|
|---|
| 5886 |
|
|---|
| 5887 | % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
|
|---|
| 5888 | % anchor), which consists of three parts:
|
|---|
| 5889 | % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \thissection,
|
|---|
| 5890 | % or the anchor name.
|
|---|
| 5891 | % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
|
|---|
| 5892 | % empty for anchors.
|
|---|
| 5893 | % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
|
|---|
| 5894 | %
|
|---|
| 5895 | % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
|
|---|
| 5896 | % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
|
|---|
| 5897 | % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
|
|---|
| 5898 | %
|
|---|
| 5899 | \def\setref#1#2{%
|
|---|
| 5900 | \pdfmkdest{#1}%
|
|---|
| 5901 | \iflinks
|
|---|
| 5902 | {%
|
|---|
| 5903 | \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
|
|---|
| 5904 | \turnoffactive
|
|---|
| 5905 | \otherbackslash
|
|---|
| 5906 | \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
|
|---|
| 5907 | \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
|
|---|
| 5908 | ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
|
|---|
| 5909 | }%
|
|---|
| 5910 | \toks0 = \expandafter{\thissection}%
|
|---|
| 5911 | \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
|
|---|
| 5912 | \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
|
|---|
| 5913 | \writexrdef{pg}{\folio}% will be written later, during \shipout
|
|---|
| 5914 | }%
|
|---|
| 5915 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5916 | }
|
|---|
| 5917 |
|
|---|
| 5918 | % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
|
|---|
| 5919 | % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
|
|---|
| 5920 | % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
|
|---|
| 5921 | % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
|
|---|
| 5922 | %
|
|---|
| 5923 | \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
|
|---|
| 5924 | \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
|
|---|
| 5925 | \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
|
|---|
| 5926 | \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 5927 | \unsepspaces
|
|---|
| 5928 | \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
|
|---|
| 5929 | \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
|
|---|
| 5930 | \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
|
|---|
| 5931 | \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
|
|---|
| 5932 | \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt
|
|---|
| 5933 | % No printed node name was explicitly given.
|
|---|
| 5934 | \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax
|
|---|
| 5935 | % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
|
|---|
| 5936 | \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
|
|---|
| 5937 | \else
|
|---|
| 5938 | % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
|
|---|
| 5939 | % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
|
|---|
| 5940 | \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
|
|---|
| 5941 | % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
|
|---|
| 5942 | \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
|
|---|
| 5943 | \else
|
|---|
| 5944 | \ifhavexrefs
|
|---|
| 5945 | % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
|
|---|
| 5946 | \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
|
|---|
| 5947 | \else
|
|---|
| 5948 | % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
|
|---|
| 5949 | \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
|
|---|
| 5950 | \fi%
|
|---|
| 5951 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5952 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5953 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5954 | %
|
|---|
| 5955 | % Make link in pdf output.
|
|---|
| 5956 | \ifpdf
|
|---|
| 5957 | \leavevmode
|
|---|
| 5958 | \getfilename{#4}%
|
|---|
| 5959 | {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash
|
|---|
| 5960 | \ifnum\filenamelength>0
|
|---|
| 5961 | \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
|
|---|
| 5962 | goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{#1}%
|
|---|
| 5963 | \else
|
|---|
| 5964 | \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
|
|---|
| 5965 | goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}%
|
|---|
| 5966 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5967 | }%
|
|---|
| 5968 | \linkcolor
|
|---|
| 5969 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5970 | %
|
|---|
| 5971 | % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
|
|---|
| 5972 | % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
|
|---|
| 5973 | % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
|
|---|
| 5974 | {%
|
|---|
| 5975 | % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
|
|---|
| 5976 | % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
|
|---|
| 5977 | \indexnofonts
|
|---|
| 5978 | \turnoffactive
|
|---|
| 5979 | \otherbackslash
|
|---|
| 5980 | \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
|
|---|
| 5981 | \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
|
|---|
| 5982 | }%
|
|---|
| 5983 | \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
|
|---|
| 5984 | % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
|
|---|
| 5985 | % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
|
|---|
| 5986 | \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt
|
|---|
| 5987 | \refx{#1-snt}%
|
|---|
| 5988 | \else
|
|---|
| 5989 | \printedrefname
|
|---|
| 5990 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5991 | %
|
|---|
| 5992 | % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
|
|---|
| 5993 | % "in MANUALNAME".
|
|---|
| 5994 | \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
|
|---|
| 5995 | \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
|
|---|
| 5996 | \fi
|
|---|
| 5997 | \else
|
|---|
| 5998 | % node/anchor (non-float) references.
|
|---|
| 5999 | %
|
|---|
| 6000 | % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
|
|---|
| 6001 | % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
|
|---|
| 6002 | % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
|
|---|
| 6003 | % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
|
|---|
| 6004 | % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
|
|---|
| 6005 | % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
|
|---|
| 6006 | \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
|
|---|
| 6007 | \putwordsection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
|
|---|
| 6008 | \else
|
|---|
| 6009 | % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
|
|---|
| 6010 | % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
|
|---|
| 6011 | % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
|
|---|
| 6012 | % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
|
|---|
| 6013 | % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
|
|---|
| 6014 | {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash
|
|---|
| 6015 | % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
|
|---|
| 6016 | % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
|
|---|
| 6017 | \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
|
|---|
| 6018 | \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
|
|---|
| 6019 | }%
|
|---|
| 6020 | % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
|
|---|
| 6021 | \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
|
|---|
| 6022 | %
|
|---|
| 6023 | % But we always want a comma and a space:
|
|---|
| 6024 | ,\space
|
|---|
| 6025 | %
|
|---|
| 6026 | % output the `page 3'.
|
|---|
| 6027 | \turnoffactive \otherbackslash \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
|
|---|
| 6028 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6029 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6030 | \endlink
|
|---|
| 6031 | \endgroup}
|
|---|
| 6032 |
|
|---|
| 6033 | % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
|
|---|
| 6034 | % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
|
|---|
| 6035 | % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
|
|---|
| 6036 | % one that Bob is working on :).
|
|---|
| 6037 | %
|
|---|
| 6038 | \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
|
|---|
| 6039 |
|
|---|
| 6040 | % Things referred to by \setref.
|
|---|
| 6041 | %
|
|---|
| 6042 | \def\Ynothing{}
|
|---|
| 6043 | \def\Yomitfromtoc{}
|
|---|
| 6044 | \def\Ynumbered{%
|
|---|
| 6045 | \ifnum\secno=0
|
|---|
| 6046 | \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
|
|---|
| 6047 | \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
|
|---|
| 6048 | \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
|
|---|
| 6049 | \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
|
|---|
| 6050 | \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
|
|---|
| 6051 | \else
|
|---|
| 6052 | \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
|
|---|
| 6053 | \fi\fi\fi
|
|---|
| 6054 | }
|
|---|
| 6055 | \def\Yappendix{%
|
|---|
| 6056 | \ifnum\secno=0
|
|---|
| 6057 | \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
|
|---|
| 6058 | \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
|
|---|
| 6059 | \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
|
|---|
| 6060 | \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
|
|---|
| 6061 | \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
|
|---|
| 6062 | \else
|
|---|
| 6063 | \putwordSection@tie
|
|---|
| 6064 | @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
|
|---|
| 6065 | \fi\fi\fi
|
|---|
| 6066 | }
|
|---|
| 6067 |
|
|---|
| 6068 | % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
|
|---|
| 6069 | % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
|
|---|
| 6070 | %
|
|---|
| 6071 | \def\refx#1#2{%
|
|---|
| 6072 | {%
|
|---|
| 6073 | \indexnofonts
|
|---|
| 6074 | \otherbackslash
|
|---|
| 6075 | \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
|
|---|
| 6076 | \csname XR#1\endcsname
|
|---|
| 6077 | }%
|
|---|
| 6078 | \ifx\thisrefX\relax
|
|---|
| 6079 | % If not defined, say something at least.
|
|---|
| 6080 | \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
|
|---|
| 6081 | \iflinks
|
|---|
| 6082 | \ifhavexrefs
|
|---|
| 6083 | \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}%
|
|---|
| 6084 | \else
|
|---|
| 6085 | \ifwarnedxrefs\else
|
|---|
| 6086 | \global\warnedxrefstrue
|
|---|
| 6087 | \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
|
|---|
| 6088 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6089 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6090 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6091 | \else
|
|---|
| 6092 | % It's defined, so just use it.
|
|---|
| 6093 | \thisrefX
|
|---|
| 6094 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6095 | #2% Output the suffix in any case.
|
|---|
| 6096 | }
|
|---|
| 6097 |
|
|---|
| 6098 | % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
|
|---|
| 6099 | % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
|
|---|
| 6100 | % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
|
|---|
| 6101 | %
|
|---|
| 6102 | \def\xrdef#1#2{%
|
|---|
| 6103 | \expandafter\gdef\csname XR#1\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref value.
|
|---|
| 6104 | %
|
|---|
| 6105 | % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
|
|---|
| 6106 | \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR#1\endcsname
|
|---|
| 6107 | % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
|
|---|
| 6108 | \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
|
|---|
| 6109 | \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
|
|---|
| 6110 | %
|
|---|
| 6111 | % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
|
|---|
| 6112 | \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
|
|---|
| 6113 | \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
|
|---|
| 6114 | \else
|
|---|
| 6115 | % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
|
|---|
| 6116 | \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
|
|---|
| 6117 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6118 | %
|
|---|
| 6119 | % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
|
|---|
| 6120 | % for later use in \listoffloats.
|
|---|
| 6121 | \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0{#1}}%
|
|---|
| 6122 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6123 | }
|
|---|
| 6124 |
|
|---|
| 6125 | % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
|
|---|
| 6126 | %
|
|---|
| 6127 | \def\tryauxfile{%
|
|---|
| 6128 | \openin 1 \jobname.aux
|
|---|
| 6129 | \ifeof 1 \else
|
|---|
| 6130 | \readauxfile
|
|---|
| 6131 | \global\havexrefstrue
|
|---|
| 6132 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6133 | \closein 1
|
|---|
| 6134 | }
|
|---|
| 6135 |
|
|---|
| 6136 | \def\readauxfile{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 6137 | \catcode`\^^@=\other
|
|---|
| 6138 | \catcode`\^^A=\other
|
|---|
| 6139 | \catcode`\^^B=\other
|
|---|
| 6140 | \catcode`\^^C=\other
|
|---|
| 6141 | \catcode`\^^D=\other
|
|---|
| 6142 | \catcode`\^^E=\other
|
|---|
| 6143 | \catcode`\^^F=\other
|
|---|
| 6144 | \catcode`\^^G=\other
|
|---|
| 6145 | \catcode`\^^H=\other
|
|---|
| 6146 | \catcode`\^^K=\other
|
|---|
| 6147 | \catcode`\^^L=\other
|
|---|
| 6148 | \catcode`\^^N=\other
|
|---|
| 6149 | \catcode`\^^P=\other
|
|---|
| 6150 | \catcode`\^^Q=\other
|
|---|
| 6151 | \catcode`\^^R=\other
|
|---|
| 6152 | \catcode`\^^S=\other
|
|---|
| 6153 | \catcode`\^^T=\other
|
|---|
| 6154 | \catcode`\^^U=\other
|
|---|
| 6155 | \catcode`\^^V=\other
|
|---|
| 6156 | \catcode`\^^W=\other
|
|---|
| 6157 | \catcode`\^^X=\other
|
|---|
| 6158 | \catcode`\^^Z=\other
|
|---|
| 6159 | \catcode`\^^[=\other
|
|---|
| 6160 | \catcode`\^^\=\other
|
|---|
| 6161 | \catcode`\^^]=\other
|
|---|
| 6162 | \catcode`\^^^=\other
|
|---|
| 6163 | \catcode`\^^_=\other
|
|---|
| 6164 | % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
|
|---|
| 6165 | % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
|
|---|
| 6166 | % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
|
|---|
| 6167 | % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
|
|---|
| 6168 | % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
|
|---|
| 6169 | % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
|
|---|
| 6170 | % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
|
|---|
| 6171 | % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
|
|---|
| 6172 | %
|
|---|
| 6173 | % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
|
|---|
| 6174 | % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
|
|---|
| 6175 | % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
|
|---|
| 6176 | %
|
|---|
| 6177 | \catcode`\^=\other
|
|---|
| 6178 | %
|
|---|
| 6179 | % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
|
|---|
| 6180 | \catcode`\~=\other
|
|---|
| 6181 | \catcode`\[=\other
|
|---|
| 6182 | \catcode`\]=\other
|
|---|
| 6183 | \catcode`\"=\other
|
|---|
| 6184 | \catcode`\_=\other
|
|---|
| 6185 | \catcode`\|=\other
|
|---|
| 6186 | \catcode`\<=\other
|
|---|
| 6187 | \catcode`\>=\other
|
|---|
| 6188 | \catcode`\$=\other
|
|---|
| 6189 | \catcode`\#=\other
|
|---|
| 6190 | \catcode`\&=\other
|
|---|
| 6191 | \catcode`\%=\other
|
|---|
| 6192 | \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
|
|---|
| 6193 | %
|
|---|
| 6194 | % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
|
|---|
| 6195 | % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
|
|---|
| 6196 | % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
|
|---|
| 6197 | % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
|
|---|
| 6198 | % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
|
|---|
| 6199 | % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
|
|---|
| 6200 | % now. --karl, 15jan04.
|
|---|
| 6201 | \catcode`\\=\other
|
|---|
| 6202 | %
|
|---|
| 6203 | % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
|
|---|
| 6204 | {%
|
|---|
| 6205 | \count 1=128
|
|---|
| 6206 | \def\loop{%
|
|---|
| 6207 | \catcode\count 1=\other
|
|---|
| 6208 | \advance\count 1 by 1
|
|---|
| 6209 | \ifnum \count 1<256 \loop \fi
|
|---|
| 6210 | }%
|
|---|
| 6211 | }%
|
|---|
| 6212 | %
|
|---|
| 6213 | % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
|
|---|
| 6214 | \catcode`\{=1
|
|---|
| 6215 | \catcode`\}=2
|
|---|
| 6216 | \catcode`\@=0
|
|---|
| 6217 | %
|
|---|
| 6218 | \input \jobname.aux
|
|---|
| 6219 | \endgroup}
|
|---|
| 6220 |
|
|---|
| 6221 |
|
|---|
| 6222 | \message{insertions,}
|
|---|
| 6223 | % including footnotes.
|
|---|
| 6224 |
|
|---|
| 6225 | \newcount \footnoteno
|
|---|
| 6226 |
|
|---|
| 6227 | % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
|
|---|
| 6228 | % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
|
|---|
| 6229 | % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
|
|---|
| 6230 | % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
|
|---|
| 6231 | % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
|
|---|
| 6232 | \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
|
|---|
| 6233 |
|
|---|
| 6234 | % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
|
|---|
| 6235 | \let\footnotestyle=\comment
|
|---|
| 6236 |
|
|---|
| 6237 | {\catcode `\@=11
|
|---|
| 6238 | %
|
|---|
| 6239 | % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
|
|---|
| 6240 | \gdef\footnote{%
|
|---|
| 6241 | \let\indent=\ptexindent
|
|---|
| 6242 | \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
|
|---|
| 6243 | \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
|
|---|
| 6244 | \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
|
|---|
| 6245 | %
|
|---|
| 6246 | % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
|
|---|
| 6247 | % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
|
|---|
| 6248 | \let\@sf\empty
|
|---|
| 6249 | \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
|
|---|
| 6250 | %
|
|---|
| 6251 | % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
|
|---|
| 6252 | \unskip
|
|---|
| 6253 | \thisfootno\@sf
|
|---|
| 6254 | \dofootnote
|
|---|
| 6255 | }%
|
|---|
| 6256 |
|
|---|
| 6257 | % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
|
|---|
| 6258 | % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
|
|---|
| 6259 | %
|
|---|
| 6260 | % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
|
|---|
| 6261 | % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
|
|---|
| 6262 | % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
|
|---|
| 6263 | %
|
|---|
| 6264 | \gdef\dofootnote{%
|
|---|
| 6265 | \insert\footins\bgroup
|
|---|
| 6266 | % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
|
|---|
| 6267 | % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
|
|---|
| 6268 | % So reset some parameters.
|
|---|
| 6269 | \hsize=\pagewidth
|
|---|
| 6270 | \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
|
|---|
| 6271 | \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
|
|---|
| 6272 | \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
|
|---|
| 6273 | \floatingpenalty\@MM
|
|---|
| 6274 | \leftskip\z@skip
|
|---|
| 6275 | \rightskip\z@skip
|
|---|
| 6276 | \spaceskip\z@skip
|
|---|
| 6277 | \xspaceskip\z@skip
|
|---|
| 6278 | \parindent\defaultparindent
|
|---|
| 6279 | %
|
|---|
| 6280 | \smallfonts \rm
|
|---|
| 6281 | %
|
|---|
| 6282 | % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
|
|---|
| 6283 | % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
|
|---|
| 6284 | % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
|
|---|
| 6285 | % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
|
|---|
| 6286 | \let\noindent = \relax
|
|---|
| 6287 | %
|
|---|
| 6288 | % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
|
|---|
| 6289 | % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
|
|---|
| 6290 | \everypar = {\hang}%
|
|---|
| 6291 | \textindent{\thisfootno}%
|
|---|
| 6292 | %
|
|---|
| 6293 | % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
|
|---|
| 6294 | % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
|
|---|
| 6295 | % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
|
|---|
| 6296 | \footstrut
|
|---|
| 6297 | \futurelet\next\fo@t
|
|---|
| 6298 | }
|
|---|
| 6299 | }%end \catcode `\@=11
|
|---|
| 6300 |
|
|---|
| 6301 | % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
|
|---|
| 6302 | % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
|
|---|
| 6303 | % would be lost.
|
|---|
| 6304 | % Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
|
|---|
| 6305 | % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
|
|---|
| 6306 | % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
|
|---|
| 6307 |
|
|---|
| 6308 | % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
|
|---|
| 6309 | % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
|
|---|
| 6310 | % out prematurely.
|
|---|
| 6311 | %
|
|---|
| 6312 | \def\startsavinginserts{%
|
|---|
| 6313 | \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
|
|---|
| 6314 | \let\insert\saveinsert
|
|---|
| 6315 | \else
|
|---|
| 6316 | \let\checkinserts\relax
|
|---|
| 6317 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6318 | }
|
|---|
| 6319 |
|
|---|
| 6320 | % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
|
|---|
| 6321 | % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
|
|---|
| 6322 | %
|
|---|
| 6323 | \def\saveinsert#1{%
|
|---|
| 6324 | \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
|
|---|
| 6325 | \afterassignment\next
|
|---|
| 6326 | % swallow the left brace
|
|---|
| 6327 | \let\temp =
|
|---|
| 6328 | }
|
|---|
| 6329 | \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
|
|---|
| 6330 | \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
|
|---|
| 6331 |
|
|---|
| 6332 | \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
|
|---|
| 6333 |
|
|---|
| 6334 | \def\placesaveins#1{%
|
|---|
| 6335 | \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
|
|---|
| 6336 | {\box#1}%
|
|---|
| 6337 | }
|
|---|
| 6338 |
|
|---|
| 6339 | % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
|
|---|
| 6340 | {
|
|---|
| 6341 | \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
|
|---|
| 6342 | \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
|
|---|
| 6343 | }
|
|---|
| 6344 |
|
|---|
| 6345 | % initialization:
|
|---|
| 6346 | \def\newsaveins #1{%
|
|---|
| 6347 | \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
|
|---|
| 6348 | \next
|
|---|
| 6349 | }
|
|---|
| 6350 | \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
|
|---|
| 6351 | \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
|
|---|
| 6352 | \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
|
|---|
| 6353 | \checksaveins #1}%
|
|---|
| 6354 | }
|
|---|
| 6355 |
|
|---|
| 6356 | % initialize:
|
|---|
| 6357 | \let\checkinserts\empty
|
|---|
| 6358 | \newsaveins\footins
|
|---|
| 6359 | \newsaveins\margin
|
|---|
| 6360 |
|
|---|
| 6361 |
|
|---|
| 6362 | % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
|
|---|
| 6363 | % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
|
|---|
| 6364 | %
|
|---|
| 6365 | % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
|
|---|
| 6366 | % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
|
|---|
| 6367 | % undone and the next image would fail.
|
|---|
| 6368 | \openin 1 = epsf.tex
|
|---|
| 6369 | \ifeof 1 \else
|
|---|
| 6370 | % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
|
|---|
| 6371 | % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
|
|---|
| 6372 | \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
|
|---|
| 6373 | \input epsf.tex
|
|---|
| 6374 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6375 | \closein 1
|
|---|
| 6376 | %
|
|---|
| 6377 | % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
|
|---|
| 6378 | \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
|
|---|
| 6379 | \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
|
|---|
| 6380 | work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
|
|---|
| 6381 | it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.}
|
|---|
| 6382 | %
|
|---|
| 6383 | \def\image#1{%
|
|---|
| 6384 | \ifx\epsfbox\undefined
|
|---|
| 6385 | \ifwarnednoepsf \else
|
|---|
| 6386 | \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
|
|---|
| 6387 | \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
|
|---|
| 6388 | \global\warnednoepsftrue
|
|---|
| 6389 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6390 | \else
|
|---|
| 6391 | \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
|
|---|
| 6392 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6393 | }
|
|---|
| 6394 | %
|
|---|
| 6395 | % Arguments to @image:
|
|---|
| 6396 | % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
|
|---|
| 6397 | % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
|
|---|
| 6398 | % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
|
|---|
| 6399 | % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
|
|---|
| 6400 | % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
|
|---|
| 6401 | \newif\ifimagevmode
|
|---|
| 6402 | \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
|
|---|
| 6403 | \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
|
|---|
| 6404 | \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
|
|---|
| 6405 | % If the image is by itself, center it.
|
|---|
| 6406 | \ifvmode
|
|---|
| 6407 | \imagevmodetrue
|
|---|
| 6408 | \nobreak\bigskip
|
|---|
| 6409 | % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
|
|---|
| 6410 | % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
|
|---|
| 6411 | % above and below.
|
|---|
| 6412 | \nobreak\vskip\parskip
|
|---|
| 6413 | \nobreak
|
|---|
| 6414 | \line\bgroup\hss
|
|---|
| 6415 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6416 | %
|
|---|
| 6417 | % Output the image.
|
|---|
| 6418 | \ifpdf
|
|---|
| 6419 | \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
|
|---|
| 6420 | \else
|
|---|
| 6421 | % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
|
|---|
| 6422 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
|
|---|
| 6423 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
|
|---|
| 6424 | \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
|
|---|
| 6425 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6426 | %
|
|---|
| 6427 | \ifimagevmode \hss \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image
|
|---|
| 6428 | \endgroup}
|
|---|
| 6429 |
|
|---|
| 6430 |
|
|---|
| 6431 | % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
|
|---|
| 6432 | % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
|
|---|
| 6433 | % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
|
|---|
| 6434 | %
|
|---|
| 6435 | \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
|
|---|
| 6436 |
|
|---|
| 6437 | % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
|
|---|
| 6438 | \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
|
|---|
| 6439 |
|
|---|
| 6440 | % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
|
|---|
| 6441 | % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
|
|---|
| 6442 | % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
|
|---|
| 6443 | %
|
|---|
| 6444 | % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
|
|---|
| 6445 | % be referable.
|
|---|
| 6446 | %
|
|---|
| 6447 | % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
|
|---|
| 6448 | % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
|
|---|
| 6449 | %
|
|---|
| 6450 | % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
|
|---|
| 6451 | % chapter-level command.
|
|---|
| 6452 | \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
|
|---|
| 6453 | %
|
|---|
| 6454 | \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
|
|---|
| 6455 | \let\thiscaption=\empty
|
|---|
| 6456 | \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
|
|---|
| 6457 | %
|
|---|
| 6458 | % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
|
|---|
| 6459 | %
|
|---|
| 6460 | % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
|
|---|
| 6461 | % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
|
|---|
| 6462 | %
|
|---|
| 6463 | \startsavinginserts
|
|---|
| 6464 | %
|
|---|
| 6465 | % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
|
|---|
| 6466 | \par
|
|---|
| 6467 | %
|
|---|
| 6468 | \vtop\bgroup
|
|---|
| 6469 | \def\floattype{#1}%
|
|---|
| 6470 | \def\floatlabel{#2}%
|
|---|
| 6471 | \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
|
|---|
| 6472 | %
|
|---|
| 6473 | \ifx\floattype\empty
|
|---|
| 6474 | \let\safefloattype=\empty
|
|---|
| 6475 | \else
|
|---|
| 6476 | {%
|
|---|
| 6477 | % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
|
|---|
| 6478 | % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
|
|---|
| 6479 | \indexnofonts
|
|---|
| 6480 | \turnoffactive
|
|---|
| 6481 | \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
|
|---|
| 6482 | }%
|
|---|
| 6483 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6484 | %
|
|---|
| 6485 | % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
|
|---|
| 6486 | \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
|
|---|
| 6487 | % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
|
|---|
| 6488 | % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
|
|---|
| 6489 | %
|
|---|
| 6490 | \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
|
|---|
| 6491 | \global\advance\floatno by 1
|
|---|
| 6492 | %
|
|---|
| 6493 | {%
|
|---|
| 6494 | % This magic value for \thissection is output by \setref as the
|
|---|
| 6495 | % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
|
|---|
| 6496 | % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
|
|---|
| 6497 | % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
|
|---|
| 6498 | % lists of floats.
|
|---|
| 6499 | %
|
|---|
| 6500 | \edef\thissection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
|
|---|
| 6501 | \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
|
|---|
| 6502 | }%
|
|---|
| 6503 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6504 | %
|
|---|
| 6505 | % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
|
|---|
| 6506 | \vskip\parskip
|
|---|
| 6507 | %
|
|---|
| 6508 | % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
|
|---|
| 6509 | \restorefirstparagraphindent
|
|---|
| 6510 | }
|
|---|
| 6511 |
|
|---|
| 6512 | % we have these possibilities:
|
|---|
| 6513 | % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
|
|---|
| 6514 | % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
|
|---|
| 6515 | % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
|
|---|
| 6516 | % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
|
|---|
| 6517 | % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
|
|---|
| 6518 | % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
|
|---|
| 6519 | % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
|
|---|
| 6520 | % @float & no caption:
|
|---|
| 6521 | %
|
|---|
| 6522 | \def\Efloat{%
|
|---|
| 6523 | \let\floatident = \empty
|
|---|
| 6524 | %
|
|---|
| 6525 | % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
|
|---|
| 6526 | \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
|
|---|
| 6527 | %
|
|---|
| 6528 | % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
|
|---|
| 6529 | \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
|
|---|
| 6530 | \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
|
|---|
| 6531 | \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
|
|---|
| 6532 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6533 | % the number.
|
|---|
| 6534 | \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
|
|---|
| 6535 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6536 | %
|
|---|
| 6537 | % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
|
|---|
| 6538 | % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
|
|---|
| 6539 | \let\captionline = \floatident
|
|---|
| 6540 | %
|
|---|
| 6541 | \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
|
|---|
| 6542 | \ifx\floatident\empty \else
|
|---|
| 6543 | \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
|
|---|
| 6544 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6545 | %
|
|---|
| 6546 | % caption text.
|
|---|
| 6547 | \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
|
|---|
| 6548 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6549 | %
|
|---|
| 6550 | % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
|
|---|
| 6551 | % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
|
|---|
| 6552 | \ifx\captionline\empty \else
|
|---|
| 6553 | \vskip.5\parskip
|
|---|
| 6554 | \captionline
|
|---|
| 6555 | %
|
|---|
| 6556 | % Space below caption.
|
|---|
| 6557 | \vskip\parskip
|
|---|
| 6558 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6559 | %
|
|---|
| 6560 | % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
|
|---|
| 6561 | % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
|
|---|
| 6562 | \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
|
|---|
| 6563 | % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
|
|---|
| 6564 | % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
|
|---|
| 6565 | % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
|
|---|
| 6566 | {%
|
|---|
| 6567 | \atdummies \turnoffactive \otherbackslash
|
|---|
| 6568 | % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
|
|---|
| 6569 | % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
|
|---|
| 6570 | % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
|
|---|
| 6571 | \scanexp{%
|
|---|
| 6572 | \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
|
|---|
| 6573 | \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
|
|---|
| 6574 | \thiscaption
|
|---|
| 6575 | \else
|
|---|
| 6576 | \thisshortcaption
|
|---|
| 6577 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6578 | }%
|
|---|
| 6579 | }%
|
|---|
| 6580 | \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
|
|---|
| 6581 | \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
|
|---|
| 6582 | }%
|
|---|
| 6583 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6584 | \egroup % end of \vtop
|
|---|
| 6585 | %
|
|---|
| 6586 | % place the captured inserts
|
|---|
| 6587 | %
|
|---|
| 6588 | % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
|
|---|
| 6589 | % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
|
|---|
| 6590 | %
|
|---|
| 6591 | \checkinserts
|
|---|
| 6592 | }
|
|---|
| 6593 |
|
|---|
| 6594 | % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
|
|---|
| 6595 | %
|
|---|
| 6596 | \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
|
|---|
| 6597 | \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
|
|---|
| 6598 | }
|
|---|
| 6599 |
|
|---|
| 6600 | % @caption, @shortcaption
|
|---|
| 6601 | %
|
|---|
| 6602 | \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
|
|---|
| 6603 | \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
|
|---|
| 6604 | \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
|
|---|
| 6605 | \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
|
|---|
| 6606 |
|
|---|
| 6607 | % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
|
|---|
| 6608 | % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
|
|---|
| 6609 | \def\getfloatno#1{%
|
|---|
| 6610 | \ifx#1\relax
|
|---|
| 6611 | % Haven't seen this figure type before.
|
|---|
| 6612 | \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
|
|---|
| 6613 | %
|
|---|
| 6614 | % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
|
|---|
| 6615 | \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
|
|---|
| 6616 | \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
|
|---|
| 6617 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6618 | \let\floatno#1%
|
|---|
| 6619 | }
|
|---|
| 6620 |
|
|---|
| 6621 | % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
|
|---|
| 6622 | % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
|
|---|
| 6623 | % first read the @float command.
|
|---|
| 6624 | %
|
|---|
| 6625 | \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
|
|---|
| 6626 |
|
|---|
| 6627 | % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
|
|---|
| 6628 | % distinguish floats from other xref types.
|
|---|
| 6629 | \def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
|
|---|
| 6630 |
|
|---|
| 6631 | % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
|
|---|
| 6632 | % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
|
|---|
| 6633 | % \thissection value which we \setref above.
|
|---|
| 6634 | %
|
|---|
| 6635 | \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
|
|---|
| 6636 | %
|
|---|
| 6637 | % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
|
|---|
| 6638 | % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
|
|---|
| 6639 | %
|
|---|
| 6640 | \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
|
|---|
| 6641 | \def\temp{#1}%
|
|---|
| 6642 | \def\iffloattype{#2}%
|
|---|
| 6643 | \ifx\temp\floatmagic
|
|---|
| 6644 | }
|
|---|
| 6645 |
|
|---|
| 6646 | % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
|
|---|
| 6647 | %
|
|---|
| 6648 | \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
|
|---|
| 6649 | \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
|
|---|
| 6650 | {%
|
|---|
| 6651 | % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
|
|---|
| 6652 | % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
|
|---|
| 6653 | \indexnofonts
|
|---|
| 6654 | \turnoffactive
|
|---|
| 6655 | \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
|
|---|
| 6656 | }%
|
|---|
| 6657 | %
|
|---|
| 6658 | % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
|
|---|
| 6659 | \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
|
|---|
| 6660 | \ifhavexrefs
|
|---|
| 6661 | % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
|
|---|
| 6662 | \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
|
|---|
| 6663 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6664 | \else
|
|---|
| 6665 | \begingroup
|
|---|
| 6666 | \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
|
|---|
| 6667 | \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
|
|---|
| 6668 | \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
|
|---|
| 6669 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 6670 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6671 | }
|
|---|
| 6672 |
|
|---|
| 6673 | % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
|
|---|
| 6674 | % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
|
|---|
| 6675 | % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
|
|---|
| 6676 | % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
|
|---|
| 6677 | %
|
|---|
| 6678 | % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
|
|---|
| 6679 | % they won't appear in the aux file).
|
|---|
| 6680 | %
|
|---|
| 6681 | \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
|
|---|
| 6682 | \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
|
|---|
| 6683 | % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
|
|---|
| 6684 | % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
|
|---|
| 6685 | % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
|
|---|
| 6686 | % in pdf output.
|
|---|
| 6687 | \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
|
|---|
| 6688 | %
|
|---|
| 6689 | % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
|
|---|
| 6690 | \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
|
|---|
| 6691 | \writeentry
|
|---|
| 6692 | }}
|
|---|
| 6693 |
|
|---|
| 6694 | \message{localization,}
|
|---|
| 6695 | % and i18n.
|
|---|
| 6696 |
|
|---|
| 6697 | % @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after
|
|---|
| 6698 | % @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything
|
|---|
| 6699 | % properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation.
|
|---|
| 6700 | % It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here.
|
|---|
| 6701 | %
|
|---|
| 6702 | \parseargdef\documentlanguage{%
|
|---|
| 6703 | \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
|
|---|
| 6704 | % Read the file if it exists.
|
|---|
| 6705 | \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
|
|---|
| 6706 | \ifeof 1
|
|---|
| 6707 | \errhelp = \nolanghelp
|
|---|
| 6708 | \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
|
|---|
| 6709 | \else
|
|---|
| 6710 | \input txi-#1.tex
|
|---|
| 6711 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6712 | \closein 1
|
|---|
| 6713 | \endgroup
|
|---|
| 6714 | }
|
|---|
| 6715 | \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
|
|---|
| 6716 | is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory
|
|---|
| 6717 | should work if nowhere else does.}
|
|---|
| 6718 |
|
|---|
| 6719 |
|
|---|
| 6720 | % @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most
|
|---|
| 6721 | % likely, but for now just recognize it.
|
|---|
| 6722 | \let\documentencoding = \comment
|
|---|
| 6723 |
|
|---|
| 6724 |
|
|---|
| 6725 | % Page size parameters.
|
|---|
| 6726 | %
|
|---|
| 6727 | \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
|
|---|
| 6728 |
|
|---|
| 6729 | \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
|
|---|
| 6730 | \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
|
|---|
| 6731 | \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
|
|---|
| 6732 |
|
|---|
| 6733 | % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
|
|---|
| 6734 | \vbadness = 10000
|
|---|
| 6735 |
|
|---|
| 6736 | % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
|
|---|
| 6737 | \hbadness = 2000
|
|---|
| 6738 |
|
|---|
| 6739 | % Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans.
|
|---|
| 6740 | \widowpenalty=10000
|
|---|
| 6741 | \clubpenalty=10000
|
|---|
| 6742 |
|
|---|
| 6743 | % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
|
|---|
| 6744 | % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
|
|---|
| 6745 | % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
|
|---|
| 6746 | % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
|
|---|
| 6747 | %
|
|---|
| 6748 | \def\setemergencystretch{%
|
|---|
| 6749 | \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
|
|---|
| 6750 | % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
|
|---|
| 6751 | \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
|
|---|
| 6752 | \else
|
|---|
| 6753 | \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
|
|---|
| 6754 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6755 | }
|
|---|
| 6756 |
|
|---|
| 6757 | % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; 3) voffset;
|
|---|
| 6758 | % 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip; 7) physical page height; 8)
|
|---|
| 6759 | % physical page width.
|
|---|
| 6760 | %
|
|---|
| 6761 | % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
|
|---|
| 6762 | % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
|
|---|
| 6763 | %
|
|---|
| 6764 | \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
|
|---|
| 6765 | \voffset = #3\relax
|
|---|
| 6766 | \topskip = #6\relax
|
|---|
| 6767 | \splittopskip = \topskip
|
|---|
| 6768 | %
|
|---|
| 6769 | \vsize = #1\relax
|
|---|
| 6770 | \advance\vsize by \topskip
|
|---|
| 6771 | \outervsize = \vsize
|
|---|
| 6772 | \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
|
|---|
| 6773 | \pageheight = \vsize
|
|---|
| 6774 | %
|
|---|
| 6775 | \hsize = #2\relax
|
|---|
| 6776 | \outerhsize = \hsize
|
|---|
| 6777 | \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
|
|---|
| 6778 | \pagewidth = \hsize
|
|---|
| 6779 | %
|
|---|
| 6780 | \normaloffset = #4\relax
|
|---|
| 6781 | \bindingoffset = #5\relax
|
|---|
| 6782 | %
|
|---|
| 6783 | \ifpdf
|
|---|
| 6784 | \pdfpageheight #7\relax
|
|---|
| 6785 | \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
|
|---|
| 6786 | \fi
|
|---|
| 6787 | %
|
|---|
| 6788 | \setleading{\textleading}
|
|---|
| 6789 | %
|
|---|
| 6790 | \parindent = \defaultparindent
|
|---|
| 6791 | \setemergencystretch
|
|---|
| 6792 | }
|
|---|
| 6793 |
|
|---|
| 6794 | % @letterpaper (the default).
|
|---|
| 6795 | \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
|
|---|
| 6796 | \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
|
|---|
| 6797 | \textleading = 13.2pt
|
|---|
| 6798 | %
|
|---|
| 6799 | % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
|
|---|
| 6800 | \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}%
|
|---|
| 6801 | {\voffset}{.25in}%
|
|---|
| 6802 | {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
|
|---|
| 6803 | {11in}{8.5in}%
|
|---|
| 6804 | }}
|
|---|
| 6805 |
|
|---|
| 6806 | % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 (or so) format.
|
|---|
| 6807 | \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
|
|---|
| 6808 | \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
|
|---|
| 6809 | \textleading = 12pt
|
|---|
| 6810 | %
|
|---|
| 6811 | \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
|
|---|
| 6812 | {\voffset}{.25in}%
|
|---|
| 6813 | {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
|
|---|
| 6814 | {9.25in}{7in}%
|
|---|
| 6815 | %
|
|---|
| 6816 | \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
|
|---|
| 6817 | \tolerance = 700
|
|---|
| 6818 | \hfuzz = 1pt
|
|---|
| 6819 | \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
|
|---|
| 6820 | \defbodyindent = .5cm
|
|---|
| 6821 | }}
|
|---|
| 6822 |
|
|---|
| 6823 | % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
|
|---|
| 6824 | \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
|
|---|
| 6825 | \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
|
|---|
| 6826 | \textleading = 13.2pt
|
|---|
| 6827 | %
|
|---|
| 6828 | % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
|
|---|
| 6829 | % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
|
|---|
| 6830 | % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
|
|---|
| 6831 | % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
|
|---|
| 6832 | % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
|
|---|
| 6833 | % your texinfo source file like this:
|
|---|
| 6834 | % @tex
|
|---|
| 6835 | % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
|
|---|
| 6836 | % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
|
|---|
| 6837 | % @end tex
|
|---|
| 6838 | \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm}
|
|---|
| 6839 | {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
|
|---|
| 6840 | {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
|
|---|
| 6841 | {297mm}{210mm}%
|
|---|
| 6842 | %
|
|---|
| 6843 | \tolerance = 700
|
|---|
| 6844 | \hfuzz = 1pt
|
|---|
| 6845 | \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
|
|---|
| 6846 | \defbodyindent = 5mm
|
|---|
| 6847 | }}
|
|---|
| 6848 |
|
|---|
| 6849 | % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
|
|---|
| 6850 | % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
|
|---|
| 6851 | % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
|
|---|
| 6852 | \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
|
|---|
| 6853 | \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
|
|---|
| 6854 | \textleading = 12.5pt
|
|---|
| 6855 | %
|
|---|
| 6856 | \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
|
|---|
| 6857 | {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
|
|---|
| 6858 | {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
|
|---|
| 6859 | {210mm}{148mm}%
|
|---|
| 6860 | %
|
|---|
| 6861 | \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
|
|---|
| 6862 | \tolerance = 800
|
|---|
| 6863 | \hfuzz = 1.2pt
|
|---|
| 6864 | \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
|
|---|
| 6865 | \defbodyindent = 2mm
|
|---|
| 6866 | \tableindent = 12mm
|
|---|
| 6867 | }}
|
|---|
| 6868 |
|
|---|
| 6869 | % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
|
|---|
| 6870 | \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
|
|---|
| 6871 | \afourpaper
|
|---|
| 6872 | \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
|
|---|
| 6873 | {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
|
|---|
| 6874 | {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
|
|---|
| 6875 | {297mm}{210mm}%
|
|---|
| 6876 | %
|
|---|
| 6877 | % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
|
|---|
| 6878 | \globaldefs = 0
|
|---|
| 6879 | }}
|
|---|
| 6880 |
|
|---|
| 6881 | % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
|
|---|
| 6882 | \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
|
|---|
| 6883 | \afourpaper
|
|---|
| 6884 | \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
|
|---|
| 6885 | {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
|
|---|
| 6886 | {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
|
|---|
| 6887 | {297mm}{210mm}%
|
|---|
| 6888 | \globaldefs = 0
|
|---|
| 6889 | }}
|
|---|
| 6890 |
|
|---|
| 6891 | % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
|
|---|
| 6892 | % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
|
|---|
| 6893 | % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
|
|---|
| 6894 | %
|
|---|
| 6895 | \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
|
|---|
| 6896 | \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
|
|---|
| 6897 | \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
|
|---|
| 6898 | \globaldefs = 1
|
|---|
| 6899 | %
|
|---|
| 6900 | \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
|
|---|
| 6901 | \setleading{\textleading}%
|
|---|
| 6902 | %
|
|---|
| 6903 | \dimen0 = #1
|
|---|
| 6904 | \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
|
|---|
| 6905 | %
|
|---|
| 6906 | \dimen2 = \hsize
|
|---|
| 6907 | \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
|
|---|
| 6908 | %
|
|---|
| 6909 | \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
|
|---|
| 6910 | {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
|
|---|
| 6911 | {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
|
|---|
| 6912 | {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
|
|---|
| 6913 | }}
|
|---|
| 6914 |
|
|---|
| 6915 | % Set default to letter.
|
|---|
| 6916 | %
|
|---|
| 6917 | \letterpaper
|
|---|
| 6918 |
|
|---|
| 6919 |
|
|---|
| 6920 | \message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
|
|---|
| 6921 |
|
|---|
| 6922 | % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
|
|---|
| 6923 | \catcode`\"=\other
|
|---|
| 6924 | \catcode`\~=\other
|
|---|
| 6925 | \catcode`\^=\other
|
|---|
| 6926 | \catcode`\_=\other
|
|---|
| 6927 | \catcode`\|=\other
|
|---|
| 6928 | \catcode`\<=\other
|
|---|
| 6929 | \catcode`\>=\other
|
|---|
| 6930 | \catcode`\+=\other
|
|---|
| 6931 | \catcode`\$=\other
|
|---|
| 6932 | \def\normaldoublequote{"}
|
|---|
| 6933 | \def\normaltilde{~}
|
|---|
| 6934 | \def\normalcaret{^}
|
|---|
| 6935 | \def\normalunderscore{_}
|
|---|
| 6936 | \def\normalverticalbar{|}
|
|---|
| 6937 | \def\normalless{<}
|
|---|
| 6938 | \def\normalgreater{>}
|
|---|
| 6939 | \def\normalplus{+}
|
|---|
| 6940 | \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
|
|---|
| 6941 |
|
|---|
| 6942 | % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
|
|---|
| 6943 | % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
|
|---|
| 6944 | % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
|
|---|
| 6945 | %
|
|---|
| 6946 | % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
|
|---|
| 6947 | % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
|
|---|
| 6948 | % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
|
|---|
| 6949 | % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
|
|---|
| 6950 | %
|
|---|
| 6951 | \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
|
|---|
| 6952 |
|
|---|
| 6953 | % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
|
|---|
| 6954 | % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
|
|---|
| 6955 | % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
|
|---|
| 6956 | % this is not a problem.
|
|---|
| 6957 | \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
|
|---|
| 6958 |
|
|---|
| 6959 | % Turn off all special characters except @
|
|---|
| 6960 | % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
|
|---|
| 6961 | % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
|
|---|
| 6962 | % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
|
|---|
| 6963 |
|
|---|
| 6964 | \catcode`\"=\active
|
|---|
| 6965 | \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
|
|---|
| 6966 | \let"=\activedoublequote
|
|---|
| 6967 | \catcode`\~=\active
|
|---|
| 6968 | \def~{{\tt\char126}}
|
|---|
| 6969 | \chardef\hat=`\^
|
|---|
| 6970 | \catcode`\^=\active
|
|---|
| 6971 | \def^{{\tt \hat}}
|
|---|
| 6972 |
|
|---|
| 6973 | \catcode`\_=\active
|
|---|
| 6974 | \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
|
|---|
| 6975 | % Subroutine for the previous macro.
|
|---|
| 6976 | \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
|
|---|
| 6977 |
|
|---|
| 6978 | \catcode`\|=\active
|
|---|
| 6979 | \def|{{\tt\char124}}
|
|---|
| 6980 | \chardef \less=`\<
|
|---|
| 6981 | \catcode`\<=\active
|
|---|
| 6982 | \def<{{\tt \less}}
|
|---|
| 6983 | \chardef \gtr=`\>
|
|---|
| 6984 | \catcode`\>=\active
|
|---|
| 6985 | \def>{{\tt \gtr}}
|
|---|
| 6986 | \catcode`\+=\active
|
|---|
| 6987 | \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
|
|---|
| 6988 | \catcode`\$=\active
|
|---|
| 6989 | \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
|
|---|
| 6990 |
|
|---|
| 6991 | % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
|
|---|
| 6992 | % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
|
|---|
| 6993 | % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
|
|---|
| 6994 | % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
|
|---|
| 6995 | \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
|
|---|
| 6996 |
|
|---|
| 6997 | \catcode`\@=0
|
|---|
| 6998 |
|
|---|
| 6999 | % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
|
|---|
| 7000 | % as in \char`\\.
|
|---|
| 7001 | \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
|
|---|
| 7002 | \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
|
|---|
| 7003 |
|
|---|
| 7004 | % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
|
|---|
| 7005 | % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
|
|---|
| 7006 | % catcode other.
|
|---|
| 7007 | {\catcode`\\=\active
|
|---|
| 7008 | @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
|
|---|
| 7009 | @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
|
|---|
| 7010 | }
|
|---|
| 7011 |
|
|---|
| 7012 | % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other.
|
|---|
| 7013 | {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\}}
|
|---|
| 7014 |
|
|---|
| 7015 | % \normalbackslash outputs one backslash in fixed width font.
|
|---|
| 7016 | \def\normalbackslash{{\tt\backslashcurfont}}
|
|---|
| 7017 |
|
|---|
| 7018 | \catcode`\\=\active
|
|---|
| 7019 |
|
|---|
| 7020 | % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters
|
|---|
| 7021 | % even after parsing them.
|
|---|
| 7022 | @def@turnoffactive{%
|
|---|
| 7023 | @let"=@normaldoublequote
|
|---|
| 7024 | @let\=@realbackslash
|
|---|
| 7025 | @let~=@normaltilde
|
|---|
| 7026 | @let^=@normalcaret
|
|---|
| 7027 | @let_=@normalunderscore
|
|---|
| 7028 | @let|=@normalverticalbar
|
|---|
| 7029 | @let<=@normalless
|
|---|
| 7030 | @let>=@normalgreater
|
|---|
| 7031 | @let+=@normalplus
|
|---|
| 7032 | @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
|
|---|
| 7033 | @unsepspaces
|
|---|
| 7034 | }
|
|---|
| 7035 |
|
|---|
| 7036 | % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
|
|---|
| 7037 | % the literal character `\'. (Thus, \ is not expandable when this is in
|
|---|
| 7038 | % effect.)
|
|---|
| 7039 | %
|
|---|
| 7040 | @def@normalturnoffactive{@turnoffactive @let\=@normalbackslash}
|
|---|
| 7041 |
|
|---|
| 7042 | % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
|
|---|
| 7043 | % This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
|
|---|
| 7044 | @otherifyactive
|
|---|
| 7045 |
|
|---|
| 7046 | % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
|
|---|
| 7047 | % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
|
|---|
| 7048 | % a backslash.
|
|---|
| 7049 | %
|
|---|
| 7050 | @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash}
|
|---|
| 7051 | @global@let\ = @eatinput
|
|---|
| 7052 |
|
|---|
| 7053 | % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
|
|---|
| 7054 | % the first `\{ in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
|
|---|
| 7055 | % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
|
|---|
| 7056 | % Also back turn on active characters that might appear in the input
|
|---|
| 7057 | % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
|
|---|
| 7058 | %
|
|---|
| 7059 | @gdef@fixbackslash{%
|
|---|
| 7060 | @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
|
|---|
| 7061 | @catcode`+=@active
|
|---|
| 7062 | @catcode`@_=@active
|
|---|
| 7063 | }
|
|---|
| 7064 |
|
|---|
| 7065 | % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
|
|---|
| 7066 | @escapechar = `@@
|
|---|
| 7067 |
|
|---|
| 7068 | % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
|
|---|
| 7069 | @catcode`@& = @other
|
|---|
| 7070 | @catcode`@# = @other
|
|---|
| 7071 | @catcode`@% = @other
|
|---|
| 7072 |
|
|---|
| 7073 |
|
|---|
| 7074 | @c Local variables:
|
|---|
| 7075 | @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
|
|---|
| 7076 | @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message"
|
|---|
| 7077 | @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
|
|---|
| 7078 | @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
|
|---|
| 7079 | @c time-stamp-end: "}"
|
|---|
| 7080 | @c End:
|
|---|
| 7081 |
|
|---|
| 7082 | @c vim:sw=2:
|
|---|
| 7083 |
|
|---|
| 7084 | @ignore
|
|---|
| 7085 | arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
|
|---|
| 7086 | @end ignore
|
|---|